* gdb.texinfo (Packets): Document vFlashErase,
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 @node Sample Session
501 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
502
503 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
504 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
505 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
506
507 @iftex
508 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
509 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
510 @end iftex
511
512 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
513 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
514
515 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
516 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
517 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
518 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
519 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
520 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
521 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
522 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
523 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
524
525 @smallexample
526 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
527 $ @b{./m4}
528 @b{define(foo,0000)}
529
530 @b{foo}
531 0000
532 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
533
534 @b{bar}
535 0000
536 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
537
538 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
539 @b{baz}
540 @b{C-d}
541 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
542 @end smallexample
543
544 @noindent
545 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
546
547 @smallexample
548 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
549 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
550 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
551 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
552 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
553 the conditions.
554 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
555 for details.
556
557 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
558 (@value{GDBP})
559 @end smallexample
560
561 @noindent
562 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
563 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
564 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
565 that examples fit in this manual.
566
567 @smallexample
568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
573 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
574 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
575 @code{break} command.
576
577 @smallexample
578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
579 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
580 @end smallexample
581
582 @noindent
583 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
584 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
585 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
589 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
590 @b{define(foo,0000)}
591
592 @b{foo}
593 0000
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
598 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
599 context where it stops.
600
601 @smallexample
602 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
603
604 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
605 at builtin.c:879
606 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
611 the next line of the current function.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
615 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
616 : nil,
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
621 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
622 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
623 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
624
625 @smallexample
626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
627 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
628 at input.c:530
629 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
634 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
635 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
636 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
637 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
638 stack frame for each active subroutine.
639
640 @smallexample
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
642 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
643 at input.c:530
644 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
645 at builtin.c:882
646 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
647 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
648 at macro.c:71
649 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
650 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
655 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
656 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
657
658 @smallexample
659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
660 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
662 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
663 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
665 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
666 : xstrdup(rq);
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
668 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
673 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
674 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
675 (@code{print}) to see their values.
676
677 @smallexample
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
679 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
681 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
686 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
687 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
691 533 xfree(rquote);
692 534
693 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
694 : xstrdup (lq);
695 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
696 : xstrdup (rq);
697 537
698 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
699 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
700 540 @}
701 541
702 542 void
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
707 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
708
709 @smallexample
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
711 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
713 540 @}
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
715 $3 = 9
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
717 $4 = 7
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
722 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
723 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
724 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
725 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
726 assignments.
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
730 $5 = 7
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
732 $6 = 9
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
737 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
738 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
739 example that caused trouble initially:
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
743 Continuing.
744
745 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
746
747 baz
748 0000
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
753 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
754 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
755
756 @smallexample
757 @b{C-d}
758 Program exited normally.
759 @end smallexample
760
761 @noindent
762 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
763 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
764 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
765
766 @smallexample
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
768 @end smallexample
769
770 @node Invocation
771 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
772
773 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
774 The essentials are:
775 @itemize @bullet
776 @item
777 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
778 @item
779 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
780 @end itemize
781
782 @menu
783 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
784 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
785 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
786 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
787 @end menu
788
789 @node Invoking GDB
790 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
791
792 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
793 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
794
795 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
796 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
797
798 The command-line options described here are designed
799 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
800 options may effectively be unavailable.
801
802 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
803 specifying an executable program:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
807 @end smallexample
808
809 @noindent
810 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
811 specified:
812
813 @smallexample
814 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
815 @end smallexample
816
817 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
818 to debug a running process:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
826 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
827
828 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
829 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
830 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
831 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
832 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
833
834 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
835 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
836 option processing.
837 @smallexample
838 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
839 @end smallexample
840 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
841 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
842
843 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
844 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
845
846 @smallexample
847 @value{GDBP} -silent
848 @end smallexample
849
850 @noindent
851 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
852 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
853
854 @noindent
855 Type
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} -help
859 @end smallexample
860
861 @noindent
862 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
863 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
864
865 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
866 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
867 @samp{-x} option is used.
868
869
870 @menu
871 * File Options:: Choosing files
872 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
873 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
874 @end menu
875
876 @node File Options
877 @subsection Choosing files
878
879 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
880 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
881 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
882 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
883 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
884 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
885 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
886 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
887 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
888 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
889 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
890 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
891 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
892
893 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
894 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
895 argument and ignore it.
896
897 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
898 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
899 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
900 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
901 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
902
903 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
904 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
905 @c it.
906
907 @table @code
908 @item -symbols @var{file}
909 @itemx -s @var{file}
910 @cindex @code{--symbols}
911 @cindex @code{-s}
912 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
913
914 @item -exec @var{file}
915 @itemx -e @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--exec}
917 @cindex @code{-e}
918 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
919 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
920
921 @item -se @var{file}
922 @cindex @code{--se}
923 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
924 file.
925
926 @item -core @var{file}
927 @itemx -c @var{file}
928 @cindex @code{--core}
929 @cindex @code{-c}
930 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
931
932 @item -c @var{number}
933 @item -pid @var{number}
934 @itemx -p @var{number}
935 @cindex @code{--pid}
936 @cindex @code{-p}
937 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
938 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
939 file named @var{number}.
940
941 @item -command @var{file}
942 @itemx -x @var{file}
943 @cindex @code{--command}
944 @cindex @code{-x}
945 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
946 Files,, Command files}.
947
948 @item -eval-command @var{command}
949 @itemx -ex @var{command}
950 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
951 @cindex @code{-ex}
952 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
953
954 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
955 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
956
957 @smallexample
958 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
959 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @item -directory @var{directory}
963 @itemx -d @var{directory}
964 @cindex @code{--directory}
965 @cindex @code{-d}
966 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
967
968 @item -r
969 @itemx -readnow
970 @cindex @code{--readnow}
971 @cindex @code{-r}
972 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
973 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
974 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
975
976 @end table
977
978 @node Mode Options
979 @subsection Choosing modes
980
981 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
982 batch mode or quiet mode.
983
984 @table @code
985 @item -nx
986 @itemx -n
987 @cindex @code{--nx}
988 @cindex @code{-n}
989 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
990 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
991 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
992 files}.
993
994 @item -quiet
995 @itemx -silent
996 @itemx -q
997 @cindex @code{--quiet}
998 @cindex @code{--silent}
999 @cindex @code{-q}
1000 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1001 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1002
1003 @item -batch
1004 @cindex @code{--batch}
1005 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1006 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1007 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1008 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1009 in the command files.
1010
1011 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1012 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1013 make this more useful, the message
1014
1015 @smallexample
1016 Program exited normally.
1017 @end smallexample
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1021 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1022 mode.
1023
1024 @item -batch-silent
1025 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1026 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1027 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1028 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1029 for an interactive session.
1030
1031 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1032 messages, for example.
1033
1034 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1035 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1036
1037 @item -return-child-result
1038 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1039 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1040 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1041
1042 @itemize @bullet
1043 @item
1044 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1045 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1046 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1047 @item
1048 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1049 @item
1050 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1051 the exit code will be -1.
1052 @end itemize
1053
1054 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1055 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1056 interface.
1057
1058 @item -nowindows
1059 @itemx -nw
1060 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1061 @cindex @code{-nw}
1062 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1063 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1064 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1065
1066 @item -windows
1067 @itemx -w
1068 @cindex @code{--windows}
1069 @cindex @code{-w}
1070 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1071 used if possible.
1072
1073 @item -cd @var{directory}
1074 @cindex @code{--cd}
1075 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1076 instead of the current directory.
1077
1078 @item -fullname
1079 @itemx -f
1080 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1081 @cindex @code{-f}
1082 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1083 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1084 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1085 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1086 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1087 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1088 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1089 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1090 frame.
1091
1092 @item -epoch
1093 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1094 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1095 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1096 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1097 separate window.
1098
1099 @item -annotate @var{level}
1100 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1101 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1102 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1103 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1104 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1105 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1106 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1107 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1108 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1109
1110 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1111 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1112
1113 @item --args
1114 @cindex @code{--args}
1115 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1116 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1117 This option stops option processing.
1118
1119 @item -baud @var{bps}
1120 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1121 @cindex @code{--baud}
1122 @cindex @code{-b}
1123 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1124 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1125
1126 @item -l @var{timeout}
1127 @cindex @code{-l}
1128 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1129 for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -tty @var{device}
1132 @itemx -t @var{device}
1133 @cindex @code{--tty}
1134 @cindex @code{-t}
1135 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1136 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1137
1138 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1139 @item -tui
1140 @cindex @code{--tui}
1141 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1142 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1143 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1144 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1145 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1146 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1147 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1148
1149 @c @item -xdb
1150 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1151 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1152 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1153 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1154 @c systems.
1155
1156 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1157 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1158 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1159 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1160 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1161 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1162
1163 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1164 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1165 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1166 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1167 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1168 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1169
1170 @item -write
1171 @cindex @code{--write}
1172 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1173 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1174 (@pxref{Patching}).
1175
1176 @item -statistics
1177 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1178 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1179 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1180
1181 @item -version
1182 @cindex @code{--version}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1184 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1185
1186 @end table
1187
1188 @node Startup
1189 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1190 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1191
1192 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1193
1194 @enumerate
1195 @item
1196 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1197 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1198
1199 @item
1200 @cindex init file
1201 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1202 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1203 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1204 that file.
1205
1206 @item
1207 Processes command line options and operands.
1208
1209 @item
1210 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1211 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1212 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1213 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1214 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1215 @value{GDBN}.
1216
1217 @item
1218 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1219 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1220
1221 @item
1222 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1223 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1224 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1225 @end enumerate
1226
1227 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1228 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1229 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1230 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1231 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1232 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1233
1234 @cindex init file name
1235 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1236 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1237 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1238 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1239 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1240 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1241 environments with special init file names:
1242
1243 @itemize @bullet
1244 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1245 @item
1246 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1247 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1248 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1249 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1250 the file to the standard name.
1251
1252 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1253 @item
1254 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1255
1256 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1257 @item
1258 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1259
1260 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1261 @item
1262 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1263
1264 @item
1265 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1266 @end itemize
1267
1268
1269 @node Quitting GDB
1270 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1271 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1272 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1273
1274 @table @code
1275 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1277 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1278 @itemx q
1279 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1280 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1281 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1282 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1283 error code.
1284 @end table
1285
1286 @cindex interrupt
1287 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1288 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1289 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1290 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1291 until a time when it is safe.
1292
1293 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1294 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1295 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1296
1297 @node Shell Commands
1298 @section Shell commands
1299
1300 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1301 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1302 just use the @code{shell} command.
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex shell
1306 @cindex shell escape
1307 @item shell @var{command string}
1308 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1309 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1310 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1311 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1312 @end table
1313
1314 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1315 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1316 @value{GDBN}:
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex make
1320 @cindex calling make
1321 @item make @var{make-args}
1322 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1323 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1324 @end table
1325
1326 @node Logging output
1327 @section Logging output
1328 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1329 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1330
1331 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1332 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @kindex set logging
1336 @item set logging on
1337 Enable logging.
1338 @item set logging off
1339 Disable logging.
1340 @cindex logging file name
1341 @item set logging file @var{file}
1342 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1343 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1344 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1345 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1346 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1347 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1348 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1349 @kindex show logging
1350 @item show logging
1351 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1352 @end table
1353
1354 @node Commands
1355 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1356
1357 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1358 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1359 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1360 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1361 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1362
1363 @menu
1364 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1365 * Completion:: Command completion
1366 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1367 @end menu
1368
1369 @node Command Syntax
1370 @section Command syntax
1371
1372 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1373 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1374 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1375 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1376 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1377 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1378
1379 @cindex abbreviation
1380 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1381 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1382 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1383 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1384 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1385 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1386 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1387
1388 @cindex repeating commands
1389 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1390 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1391 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1392 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1393 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1394 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1395 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1396
1397 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1398 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1399 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1400
1401 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1402 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1403 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1404 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1405 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1406
1407 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1408 @cindex comment
1409 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1410 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1411 Files,,Command files}).
1412
1413 @cindex repeating command sequences
1414 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1415 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1416 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1417 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1418 for editing.
1419
1420 @node Completion
1421 @section Command completion
1422
1423 @cindex completion
1424 @cindex word completion
1425 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1426 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1427 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1428 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1429
1430 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1431 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1432 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1433 enter it). For example, if you type
1434
1435 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1436 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1437 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1438 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1439 @smallexample
1440 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1441 @end smallexample
1442
1443 @noindent
1444 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1445 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1446
1447 @smallexample
1448 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1449 @end smallexample
1450
1451 @noindent
1452 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1453 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1454 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1455 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1456 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1457 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1458
1459 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1460 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1461 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1462 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1463 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1464 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1465 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1466 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1467 example:
1468
1469 @smallexample
1470 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1471 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1472 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1473 make_abs_section make_function_type
1474 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1475 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1476 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1478 @end smallexample
1479
1480 @noindent
1481 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1482 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1483 command.
1484
1485 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1486 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1487 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1488 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1489 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1490
1491 @cindex quotes in commands
1492 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1493 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1494 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1495 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1496 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1497 @value{GDBN} commands.
1498
1499 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1500 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1501 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1502 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1503 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1504 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1505 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1506 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1507 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1508 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1509 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1513 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1518 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1519 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1520 place:
1521
1522 @smallexample
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1524 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1525 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1526 @end smallexample
1527
1528 @noindent
1529 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1530 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1531 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1532
1533 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1534 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1535 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1536 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1537
1538
1539 @node Help
1540 @section Getting help
1541 @cindex online documentation
1542 @kindex help
1543
1544 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1545 using the command @code{help}.
1546
1547 @table @code
1548 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1549 @item help
1550 @itemx h
1551 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1552 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1553
1554 @smallexample
1555 (@value{GDBP}) help
1556 List of classes of commands:
1557
1558 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1559 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1560 data -- Examining data
1561 files -- Specifying and examining files
1562 internals -- Maintenance commands
1563 obscure -- Obscure features
1564 running -- Running the program
1565 stack -- Examining the stack
1566 status -- Status inquiries
1567 support -- Support facilities
1568 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1569 stopping the program
1570 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1571
1572 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1573 commands in that class.
1574 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1575 documentation.
1576 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1577 (@value{GDBP})
1578 @end smallexample
1579 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1580
1581 @item help @var{class}
1582 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1583 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1584 help display for the class @code{status}:
1585
1586 @smallexample
1587 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1588 Status inquiries.
1589
1590 List of commands:
1591
1592 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1593 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1594 info -- Generic command for showing things
1595 about the program being debugged
1596 show -- Generic command for showing things
1597 about the debugger
1598
1599 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1600 documentation.
1601 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1602 (@value{GDBP})
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @item help @var{command}
1606 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1607 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1608
1609 @kindex apropos
1610 @item apropos @var{args}
1611 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1612 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1613 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 apropos reload
1617 @end smallexample
1618
1619 @noindent
1620 results in:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 @c @group
1624 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1625 multiple times in one run
1626 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1627 multiple times in one run
1628 @c @end group
1629 @end smallexample
1630
1631 @kindex complete
1632 @item complete @var{args}
1633 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1634 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1635 command you want completed. For example:
1636
1637 @smallexample
1638 complete i
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent results in:
1642
1643 @smallexample
1644 @group
1645 if
1646 ignore
1647 info
1648 inspect
1649 @end group
1650 @end smallexample
1651
1652 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1653 @end table
1654
1655 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1656 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1657 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1658 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1659 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1660 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1661
1662 @c @group
1663 @table @code
1664 @kindex info
1665 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1666 @item info
1667 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1668 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1669 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1670 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1671 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1672 @w{@code{help info}}.
1673
1674 @kindex set
1675 @item set
1676 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1677 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1678 @code{set prompt $}.
1679
1680 @kindex show
1681 @item show
1682 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1683 @value{GDBN} itself.
1684 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1685 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1686 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1687 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1688
1689 @kindex info set
1690 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1691 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1692 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1693 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1694 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1695 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1696 @end table
1697 @c @end group
1698
1699 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1700 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1701
1702 @table @code
1703 @kindex show version
1704 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1705 @item show version
1706 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1707 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1708 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1709 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1710 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1711 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1712 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1713 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1714 @value{GDBN}.
1715
1716 @kindex show copying
1717 @kindex info copying
1718 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1719 @item show copying
1720 @itemx info copying
1721 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1722
1723 @kindex show warranty
1724 @kindex info warranty
1725 @item show warranty
1726 @itemx info warranty
1727 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1728 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1729
1730 @end table
1731
1732 @node Running
1733 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1734
1735 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1736 debugging information when you compile it.
1737
1738 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1739 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1740 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1741 kill a child process.
1742
1743 @menu
1744 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1745 * Starting:: Starting your program
1746 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1747 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1748
1749 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1750 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1751 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1752 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1753
1754 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1755 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1756 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1757 @end menu
1758
1759 @node Compilation
1760 @section Compiling for debugging
1761
1762 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1763 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1764 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1765 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1766 and addresses in the executable code.
1767
1768 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1769 the compiler.
1770
1771 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1772 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1773 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1774 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1775 executables containing debugging information.
1776
1777 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1778 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1779 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1780 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1781 in pushing your luck.
1782
1783 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1784 @cindex debugging optimized code
1785 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1786 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1787 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1788 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1789 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1790 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1791
1792 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1793 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1794 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1795 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1796 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1797
1798 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1799 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1800 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1801
1802 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1803 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1804 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1805 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1806 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1807 provides macro information if you specify the options
1808 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1809 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1810 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1811 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1812 @option{-g} alone.
1813
1814 @need 2000
1815 @node Starting
1816 @section Starting your program
1817 @cindex starting
1818 @cindex running
1819
1820 @table @code
1821 @kindex run
1822 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1823 @item run
1824 @itemx r
1825 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1826 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1827 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1828 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1829 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1830
1831 @end table
1832
1833 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1834 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1835 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1836 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1837
1838 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1839 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1840 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1841 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1842 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1843 divided into four categories:
1844
1845 @table @asis
1846 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1847 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1848 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1849 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1850 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1851 the arguments.
1852 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1853 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1854 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1855
1856 @item The @emph{environment.}
1857 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1858 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1859 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1860 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1861
1862 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1863 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1864 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1865 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1868 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1869 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1870 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1871 set a different device for your program.
1872 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1873
1874 @cindex pipes
1875 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1876 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1877 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1878 wrong program.
1879 @end table
1880
1881 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1882 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1883 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1884 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1885 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1886
1887 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1888 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1889 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1890 your current breakpoints.
1891
1892 @table @code
1893 @kindex start
1894 @item start
1895 @cindex run to main procedure
1896 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1897 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1898 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1899 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1900 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1901 procedure, depending on the language used.
1902
1903 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1904 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1905 the @samp{run} command.
1906
1907 @cindex elaboration phase
1908 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1909 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1910 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1911 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1912 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1913 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1914 will remain to halt execution.
1915
1916 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1917 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1918 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1919 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1920 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1921
1922 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1923 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1924 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1925 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1926 elaboration code before running your program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 @node Arguments
1930 @section Your program's arguments
1931
1932 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1933 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1934 @code{run} command.
1935 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1936 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1937 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1938 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1939 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1940
1941 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1942 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1943 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1944 the program, not by the shell.
1945
1946 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1947 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1948
1949 @table @code
1950 @kindex set args
1951 @item set args
1952 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1953 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1954 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1955 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1956 it again without arguments.
1957
1958 @kindex show args
1959 @item show args
1960 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 @node Environment
1964 @section Your program's environment
1965
1966 @cindex environment (of your program)
1967 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1968 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1969 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1970 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1971 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1972 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1973 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1974
1975 @table @code
1976 @kindex path
1977 @item path @var{directory}
1978 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1979 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1980 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1981 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1982 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1983 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1984 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1985
1986 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1987 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1988 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1989 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1990 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1991 @var{directory} to the search path.
1992 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1993 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1994
1995 @kindex show paths
1996 @item show paths
1997 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1998 environment variable).
1999
2000 @kindex show environment
2001 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2002 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2003 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2004 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2005 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2006
2007 @kindex set environment
2008 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2009 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2010 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2011 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2012 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2013 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2014 null value.
2015 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2016 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2017
2018 For example, this command:
2019
2020 @smallexample
2021 set env USER = foo
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2026 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2027 are not actually required.)
2028
2029 @kindex unset environment
2030 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2031 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2032 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2033 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2034 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2035 @end table
2036
2037 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2038 the shell indicated
2039 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2040 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2041 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2042 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2043 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2044 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2045 @file{.profile}.
2046
2047 @node Working Directory
2048 @section Your program's working directory
2049
2050 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2051 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2052 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2053 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2054 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2055 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2056
2057 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2058 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2059 specify files}.
2060
2061 @table @code
2062 @kindex cd
2063 @cindex change working directory
2064 @item cd @var{directory}
2065 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2066
2067 @kindex pwd
2068 @item pwd
2069 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2070 @end table
2071
2072 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2073 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2074 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2075 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2076 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2077 current working directory of the debuggee.
2078
2079 @node Input/Output
2080 @section Your program's input and output
2081
2082 @cindex redirection
2083 @cindex i/o
2084 @cindex terminal
2085 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2086 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2087 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2088 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2089 running your program.
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @kindex info terminal
2093 @item info terminal
2094 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2095 program is using.
2096 @end table
2097
2098 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2099 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2100
2101 @smallexample
2102 run > outfile
2103 @end smallexample
2104
2105 @noindent
2106 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2107
2108 @kindex tty
2109 @cindex controlling terminal
2110 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2111 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2112 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2113 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2114 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2115
2116 @smallexample
2117 tty /dev/ttyb
2118 @end smallexample
2119
2120 @noindent
2121 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2122 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2123 that as their controlling terminal.
2124
2125 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2126 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2127 terminal.
2128
2129 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2130 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2131 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2132 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2133
2134 @cindex inferior tty
2135 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2136 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2137 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2138 program.
2139
2140 @table @code
2141 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2142 @kindex set inferior-tty
2143 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2144
2145 @item show inferior-tty
2146 @kindex show inferior-tty
2147 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2148 @end table
2149
2150 @node Attach
2151 @section Debugging an already-running process
2152 @kindex attach
2153 @cindex attach
2154
2155 @table @code
2156 @item attach @var{process-id}
2157 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2158 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2159 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2160 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2161 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2162
2163 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2164 executing the command.
2165 @end table
2166
2167 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2168 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2169 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2170 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2171
2172 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2173 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2174 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2175 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2176 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2177 Specify Files}.
2178
2179 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2180 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2181 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2182 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2183 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2184 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2185 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex detach
2189 @item detach
2190 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2191 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2192 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2193 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2194 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2195 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2196 executing the command.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2200 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2201 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2202 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2203 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2204 messages}).
2205
2206 @node Kill Process
2207 @section Killing the child process
2208
2209 @table @code
2210 @kindex kill
2211 @item kill
2212 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2213 @end table
2214
2215 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2216 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2217 is running.
2218
2219 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2220 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2221 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2222 outside the debugger.
2223
2224 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2225 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2226 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2227 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2228 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2229 breakpoint settings).
2230
2231 @node Threads
2232 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2233
2234 @cindex threads of execution
2235 @cindex multiple threads
2236 @cindex switching threads
2237 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2238 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2239 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2240 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2241 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2242 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2243 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2244
2245 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2246 programs:
2247
2248 @itemize @bullet
2249 @item automatic notification of new threads
2250 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2251 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2252 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2253 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2254 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2255 @end itemize
2256
2257 @quotation
2258 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2259 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2260 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2261 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2262 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2263 like this:
2264
2265 @smallexample
2266 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2267 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2268 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2269 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2270 @end smallexample
2271 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2272 @c doesn't support threads"?
2273 @end quotation
2274
2275 @cindex focus of debugging
2276 @cindex current thread
2277 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2278 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2279 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2280 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2281 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2282
2283 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2284 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2285 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2286 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2287 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2288 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2289 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2290 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2291 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2292 LynxOS, you might see
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 [New process 35 thread 27]
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2300 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2301 further qualifier.
2302
2303 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2304 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2305 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2306 @c program?
2307 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2308 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2309 @c threads ab initio?
2310
2311 @cindex thread number
2312 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2313 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2314 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex info threads
2318 @item info threads
2319 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2320 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2321
2322 @enumerate
2323 @item
2324 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2325
2326 @item
2327 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2328
2329 @item
2330 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2331 @end enumerate
2332
2333 @noindent
2334 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2335 indicates the current thread.
2336
2337 For example,
2338 @end table
2339 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2340
2341 @smallexample
2342 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2343 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2344 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2345 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2346 at threadtest.c:68
2347 @end smallexample
2348
2349 On HP-UX systems:
2350
2351 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2352 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2353 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2354 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2355 thread in your program.
2356
2357 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2358 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2359 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2360 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2361 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2362 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2363 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2364 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2365 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2366 HP-UX, you see
2367
2368 @smallexample
2369 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2370 @end smallexample
2371
2372 @noindent
2373 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2374
2375 @table @code
2376 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2377 @item info threads
2378 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2379 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2380
2381 @enumerate
2382 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2383
2384 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2385
2386 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2387 @end enumerate
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2391 indicates the current thread.
2392
2393 For example,
2394 @end table
2395 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2399 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2400 at quicksort.c:137
2401 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2402 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2403 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2404 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2405 @end smallexample
2406
2407 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2408 Solaris-specific command:
2409
2410 @table @code
2411 @item maint info sol-threads
2412 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2413 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2414 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2415 @end table
2416
2417 @table @code
2418 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2419 @item thread @var{threadno}
2420 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2421 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2422 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2423 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2424 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2428 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2429 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2430 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2431 @end smallexample
2432
2433 @noindent
2434 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2435 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2436 threads.
2437
2438 @kindex thread apply
2439 @cindex apply command to several threads
2440 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2441 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2442 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2443 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2444 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2445 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2446 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2447 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2448 @end table
2449
2450 @cindex automatic thread selection
2451 @cindex switching threads automatically
2452 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2453 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2454 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2455 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2456 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2457 thread.
2458
2459 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2460 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2461 programs with multiple threads.
2462
2463 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2464 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2465
2466 @node Processes
2467 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2468
2469 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2470 @cindex multiple processes
2471 @cindex processes, multiple
2472 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2473 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2474 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2475 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2476 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2477 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2478 will cause it to terminate.
2479
2480 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2481 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2482 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2483 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2484 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2485 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2486 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2487 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2488 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2489 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2490
2491 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2492 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2493 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2494 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2495
2496 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2497 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2498
2499 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2500 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2501
2502 @table @code
2503 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2504 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2505 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2506 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2507 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @item parent
2511 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2512 unimpeded. This is the default.
2513
2514 @item child
2515 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2516 unimpeded.
2517
2518 @end table
2519
2520 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2521 @item show follow-fork-mode
2522 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2526 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2527 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2528
2529 @table @code
2530 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2531 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2532 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2533 retain debugger control over them both.
2534
2535 @table @code
2536 @item on
2537 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2538 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2539 independently. This is the default.
2540
2541 @item off
2542 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2543 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2544 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2545 is held suspended.
2546
2547 @end table
2548
2549 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2550 @item show detach-on-follow
2551 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2552 @end table
2553
2554 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2555 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2556 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2557 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2558 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2559
2560 @table @code
2561 @kindex info forks
2562 @item info forks
2563 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2564 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2565 position (program counter) of the process.
2566
2567
2568 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2569 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2570 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2571 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2572 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2573
2574 @end table
2575
2576 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2577 from it by using the @w{@code{detach-fork}} command (allowing it to
2578 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2579 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2580
2581 @table @code
2582 @kindex detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2583 @item detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2584 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2585 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2586 allowed to run independently.
2587
2588 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2589 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2590 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2591 and remove it from the fork list.
2592
2593 @end table
2594
2595 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2596 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2597 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2598 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2599 the child process's @code{main}.
2600
2601 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2602 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2603
2604 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2605 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2606 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2607 argument.
2608
2609 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2610 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2611 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2612
2613 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2614 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2615
2616 @cindex checkpoint
2617 @cindex restart
2618 @cindex bookmark
2619 @cindex snapshot of a process
2620 @cindex rewind program state
2621
2622 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2623 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2624 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2625 later.
2626
2627 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2628 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2629 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2630 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2631 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2632
2633 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2634 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2635 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2636 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2637 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2638 start again from there.
2639
2640 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2641 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2642
2643 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2644
2645 @table @code
2646 @kindex checkpoint
2647 @item checkpoint
2648 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2649 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2650 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2651
2652 @kindex info checkpoints
2653 @item info checkpoints
2654 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2655 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2656 listed:
2657
2658 @table @code
2659 @item Checkpoint ID
2660 @item Process ID
2661 @item Code Address
2662 @item Source line, or label
2663 @end table
2664
2665 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2666 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2667 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2668 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2669 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2670 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2671 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2672
2673 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2674 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2675 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2676 the debugger.
2677
2678 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2679 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2680 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2681
2682 @end table
2683
2684 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2685 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2686 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2687 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2688 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2689 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2690 previously read data can be read again.
2691
2692 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2693 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2694 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2695 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2696 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2697 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2698
2699 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2700 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2701 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2702 different execution path this time.
2703
2704 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2705 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2706 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2707 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2708 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2709 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2710 potentially pose a problem.
2711
2712 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2713
2714 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2715 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2716 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2717 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2718 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2719 next.
2720
2721 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2722 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2723 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2724 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2725 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2726
2727 @node Stopping
2728 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2729
2730 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2731 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2732 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2733
2734 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2735 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2736 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2737 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2738 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2739 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2740 explicitly request this information at any time.
2741
2742 @table @code
2743 @kindex info program
2744 @item info program
2745 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2746 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2747 @end table
2748
2749 @menu
2750 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2751 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2752 * Signals:: Signals
2753 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2754 @end menu
2755
2756 @node Breakpoints
2757 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2758
2759 @cindex breakpoints
2760 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2761 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2762 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2763 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2764 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2765 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2766 program.
2767
2768 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2769 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2770 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2771 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2772 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2773 call).
2774
2775 @cindex watchpoints
2776 @cindex memory tracing
2777 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2778 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2779 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2781 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2782 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2783 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2784 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2785
2786 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2787 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2788 Automatic display}.
2789
2790 @cindex catchpoints
2791 @cindex breakpoint on events
2792 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2793 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2794 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2795 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2796 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2797 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2798 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2799
2800 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2801 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2802 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2803 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2804 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2805 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2806 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2807 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2808 enable it again.
2809
2810 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2811 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2812 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2813 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2814 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2815 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2816 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2817
2818 @menu
2819 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2820 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2821 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2822 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2823 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2824 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2825 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2826 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2827 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2828 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2829 @end menu
2830
2831 @node Set Breaks
2832 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2833
2834 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2835 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2836 @c
2837 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2838
2839 @kindex break
2840 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2841 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2842 @cindex latest breakpoint
2843 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2844 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2845 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2846 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2847 convenience variables.
2848
2849 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2850
2851 @table @code
2852 @item break @var{function}
2853 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2854 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2855 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2856 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2857
2858 @item break +@var{offset}
2859 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2860 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2861 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2862 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2863
2864 @item break @var{linenum}
2865 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2866 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2867 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2868 code on that line.
2869
2870 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2871 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2872
2873 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2874 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2875 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2876 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2877 functions.
2878
2879 @item break *@var{address}
2880 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2881 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2882 information or source files.
2883
2884 @item break
2885 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2886 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2887 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2888 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2889 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2890 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2891 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2892 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2893 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2894 inside loops.
2895
2896 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2897 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2898 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2899 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2900 existed when your program stopped.
2901
2902 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2903 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2904 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2905 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2906 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2907 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2908 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2909
2910 @kindex tbreak
2911 @item tbreak @var{args}
2912 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2913 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2914 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2915 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2916
2917 @kindex hbreak
2918 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2919 @item hbreak @var{args}
2920 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2921 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2922 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2923 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2924 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2925 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2926 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2927 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2928 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2929 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2930 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2931 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2932 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2933 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2934 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2935 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2936 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2937
2938
2939 @kindex thbreak
2940 @item thbreak @var{args}
2941 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2942 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2943 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2944 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2945 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2946 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2947 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2948 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2949
2950 @kindex rbreak
2951 @cindex regular expression
2952 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2953 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2954 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2955 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2956 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2957 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2958 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2959 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2960 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2961
2962 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2963 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2964 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2965 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2966 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2967 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2968
2969 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2970 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2971 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2972 classes.
2973
2974 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2975 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2976 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2977
2978 @smallexample
2979 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2980 @end smallexample
2981
2982 @kindex info breakpoints
2983 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2984 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2985 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2986 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2987 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2988 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2989
2990 @table @emph
2991 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2992 @item Type
2993 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2994 @item Disposition
2995 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2996 @item Enabled or Disabled
2997 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2998 that are not enabled.
2999 @item Address
3000 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3001 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3002 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3003 @item What
3004 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3005 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3006 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3007 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3008 @end table
3009
3010 @noindent
3011 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3012 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3013 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3014 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3015 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3016 valid location.
3017
3018 @noindent
3019 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3020 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3021 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3022 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3023 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3024
3025 @noindent
3026 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3027 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3028 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3029 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3030 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3031 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3032 @end table
3033
3034 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3035 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3036 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3037 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3038
3039 @cindex pending breakpoints
3040 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3041 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3042 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3043 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3044 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3045 gets loaded.
3046
3047 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3048 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3049 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3050 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3051 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3052 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3053
3054 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3055 breakpoint support:
3056
3057 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3058 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3059 @table @code
3060 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3061 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3062 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3063
3064 @item set breakpoint pending on
3065 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3066 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3067
3068 @item set breakpoint pending off
3069 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3070 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3071 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3072
3073 @item show breakpoint pending
3074 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3075 @end table
3076
3077 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3078 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3079 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3080 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3081 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3082 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3083 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3084 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3085 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3086 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3087 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3088 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3089 of these loads could resolve the location.
3090
3091 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3092 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3093 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3094 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3095 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3096 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3097 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3098 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3099
3100
3101 @node Set Watchpoints
3102 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3103
3104 @cindex setting watchpoints
3105 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3106 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3107 this may happen.
3108
3109 @cindex software watchpoints
3110 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3111 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3112 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3113 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3114 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3115 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3116 culprit.)
3117
3118 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3119 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3120 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3121
3122 @table @code
3123 @kindex watch
3124 @item watch @var{expr}
3125 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
3126 is written into by the program and its value changes.
3127
3128 @kindex rwatch
3129 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3131 by the program.
3132
3133 @kindex awatch
3134 @item awatch @var{expr}
3135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3136 or written into by the program.
3137
3138 @kindex info watchpoints
3139 @item info watchpoints
3140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3141 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3142 @end table
3143
3144 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3145 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3146 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3147 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3148 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3149 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3150
3151 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3152 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3153 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3154 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3155 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3156 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3157 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3158 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3159
3160 @table @code
3161 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3162 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3163 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3164
3165 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3166 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3167 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3171 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3172 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3173
3174 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3175
3176 @smallexample
3177 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3178 @end smallexample
3179
3180 @noindent
3181 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3182
3183 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3184 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3185 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3186 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3187 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3188 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3189 will print a message like this:
3190
3191 @smallexample
3192 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3193 @end smallexample
3194
3195 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3196 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3197 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3198 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3199 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3200 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3201 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3202 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3203
3204 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3205 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3206 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3207 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3208 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3209 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3210
3211 @smallexample
3212 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3213 @end smallexample
3214
3215 @noindent
3216 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3217
3218 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3219 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3220 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3221 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3222 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3223 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3224 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3225 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3226 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3227 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3228
3229 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3230 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3231 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3232
3233 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3234 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3235 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3236 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3237 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3238 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3239 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3240 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3241 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3242
3243 @quotation
3244 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3245 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3246 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3247 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3248 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3249 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3250 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3251 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3252 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3253 the expression.
3254
3255 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3256 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3257 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3258 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3259 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3260 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3261 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3262 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3263 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3264 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3265 @end quotation
3266
3267 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3268
3269 @node Set Catchpoints
3270 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3271 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3272 @cindex exception handlers
3273 @cindex event handling
3274
3275 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3276 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3277 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @kindex catch
3281 @item catch @var{event}
3282 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3283 @table @code
3284 @item throw
3285 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3286 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3287
3288 @item catch
3289 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3290
3291 @item exec
3292 @cindex break on fork/exec
3293 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3294
3295 @item fork
3296 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3297
3298 @item vfork
3299 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3300
3301 @item load
3302 @itemx load @var{libname}
3303 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3304 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3305 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3306
3307 @item unload
3308 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3309 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3310 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3311 @end table
3312
3313 @item tcatch @var{event}
3314 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3315 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3316
3317 @end table
3318
3319 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3320
3321 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3322 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3323
3324 @itemize @bullet
3325 @item
3326 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3327 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3328 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3329 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3330 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3331 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3332 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3333 disabled within interactive calls.
3334
3335 @item
3336 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3337
3338 @item
3339 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3340 @end itemize
3341
3342 @cindex raise exceptions
3343 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3344 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3345 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3346 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3347 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3348 out where the exception was raised.
3349
3350 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3351 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3352 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3353 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3354
3355 @smallexample
3356 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3357 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3358 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3359 @end smallexample
3360
3361 @noindent
3362 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3363 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3364 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3365
3366 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3367 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3368 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3369 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3370 raised.
3371
3372
3373 @node Delete Breaks
3374 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3375
3376 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3377 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3378 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3379 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3380 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3381 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3382
3383 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3384 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3385 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3386 their breakpoint numbers.
3387
3388 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3389 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3390 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3391
3392 @table @code
3393 @kindex clear
3394 @item clear
3395 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3396 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3397 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3398 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3399
3400 @item clear @var{function}
3401 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3402 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3403
3404 @item clear @var{linenum}
3405 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3406 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3407 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3408
3409 @cindex delete breakpoints
3410 @kindex delete
3411 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3412 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3413 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3414 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3415 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3416 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3417 @end table
3418
3419 @node Disabling
3420 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3421
3422 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3423 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3424 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3425 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3426 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3427
3428 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3429 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3430 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3431 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3432 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3433
3434 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3435 states of enablement:
3436
3437 @itemize @bullet
3438 @item
3439 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3440 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3441 @item
3442 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3443 @item
3444 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3445 disabled.
3446 @item
3447 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3448 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3449 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3450 @end itemize
3451
3452 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3453 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3454
3455 @table @code
3456 @kindex disable
3457 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3458 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3459 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3460 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3461 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3462 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3463 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3464
3465 @kindex enable
3466 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3467 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3468 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3469
3470 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3471 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3472 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3473
3474 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3475 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3476 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3477 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3478 @end table
3479
3480 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3481 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3482 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3483 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3484 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3485 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3486 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3487 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3488 stepping}.)
3489
3490 @node Conditions
3491 @subsection Break conditions
3492 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3493 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3494
3495 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3496 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3497 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3498 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3499 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3500 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3501 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3502 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3503
3504 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3505 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3506 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3507 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3508 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3509
3510 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3511 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3512 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3513 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3514 one.
3515
3516 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3517 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3518 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3519 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3520 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3521 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3522 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3523 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3524 conditions for the
3525 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3526 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3527
3528 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3529 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3530 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3531 with the @code{condition} command.
3532
3533 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3534 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3535 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3536 catchpoint.
3537
3538 @table @code
3539 @kindex condition
3540 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3541 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3542 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3543 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3544 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3545 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3546 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3547 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3548 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3549 prints an error message:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3553 @end smallexample
3554
3555 @noindent
3556 @value{GDBN} does
3557 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3558 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3559 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3560
3561 @item condition @var{bnum}
3562 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3563 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3564 @end table
3565
3566 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3567 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3568 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3569 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3570 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3571 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3572 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3573 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3574 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3575 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3576 your program reaches it.
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @kindex ignore
3580 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3581 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3582 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3583 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3584 takes no action.
3585
3586 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3587 a count of zero.
3588
3589 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3590 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3591 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3592 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3593
3594 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3595 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3596 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3597
3598 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3599 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3600 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3601 variables}.
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3605
3606
3607 @node Break Commands
3608 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3609
3610 @cindex breakpoint commands
3611 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3612 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3613 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3614 enable other breakpoints.
3615
3616 @table @code
3617 @kindex commands
3618 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3619 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3620 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3621 @itemx end
3622 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3623 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3624 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3625
3626 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3627 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3628
3629 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3630 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3631 recently encountered).
3632 @end table
3633
3634 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3635 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3636
3637 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3638 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3639 that resumes execution.
3640
3641 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3642 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3643 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3644 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3645 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3646
3647 @kindex silent
3648 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3649 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3650 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3651 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3652 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3653 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3654
3655 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3656 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3657 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3658
3659 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3660 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3661
3662 @smallexample
3663 break foo if x>0
3664 commands
3665 silent
3666 printf "x is %d\n",x
3667 cont
3668 end
3669 @end smallexample
3670
3671 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3672 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3673 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3674 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3675 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3676 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3677 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3678
3679 @smallexample
3680 break 403
3681 commands
3682 silent
3683 set x = y + 4
3684 cont
3685 end
3686 @end smallexample
3687
3688 @node Breakpoint Menus
3689 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3690 @cindex overloading
3691 @cindex symbol overloading
3692
3693 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3694 single function name
3695 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3696 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3697 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3698 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3699 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3700 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3701 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3702 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3703 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3704 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3705 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3706 breakpoints.
3707
3708 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3709 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3710 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3711
3712 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3713 @smallexample
3714 @group
3715 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3716 [0] cancel
3717 [1] all
3718 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3719 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3720 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3721 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3722 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3723 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3724 > 2 4 6
3725 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3726 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3727 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3728 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3729 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3730 breakpoints.
3731 (@value{GDBP})
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3736 @node Error in Breakpoints
3737 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3738 @c
3739 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3740 @c
3741 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3742 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3743 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3744 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3745
3746 @smallexample
3747 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3748 The same program may be running in another process.
3749 @end smallexample
3750
3751 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3752
3753 @enumerate
3754 @item
3755 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3756
3757 @item
3758 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3759 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3760 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3761 Then start your program again.
3762
3763 @item
3764 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3765 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3766 to nonsharable executables.
3767 @end enumerate
3768 @c @end ifclear
3769
3770 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3771 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3772
3773 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3774 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3775 @smallexample
3776 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3777 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3778 @end smallexample
3779
3780 @noindent
3781 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3782 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3783 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3784
3785 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3786 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3787
3788 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3789 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3790 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3791
3792 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3793 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3794 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3795 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3796
3797 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3798 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3799 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3800 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3801 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3802 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3803 first in the bundle.
3804
3805 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3806 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3807 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3808 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3809 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3810 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3811 is hit.
3812
3813 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3814 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3815
3816 @smallexample
3817 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3821 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3822 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3823 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3824 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3825 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3826 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3827 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3828
3829 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3830 adjusted breakpoints:
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3834 to 0x00010410.
3835 @end smallexample
3836
3837 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3838 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3839 frequently than expected.
3840
3841 @node Continuing and Stepping
3842 @section Continuing and stepping
3843
3844 @cindex stepping
3845 @cindex continuing
3846 @cindex resuming execution
3847 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3848 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3849 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3850 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3851 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3852 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3853 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3854 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3855
3856 @table @code
3857 @kindex continue
3858 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3859 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3860 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3861 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3862 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3863 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3864 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3865 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3866 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3867 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3868
3869 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3870 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3871 @code{continue} is ignored.
3872
3873 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3874 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3875 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3876 @code{continue}.
3877 @end table
3878
3879 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3880 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3881 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3882 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3883
3884 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3885 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3886 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3887 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3888 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3889 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3890
3891 @table @code
3892 @kindex step
3893 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3894 @item step
3895 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3896 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3897 abbreviated @code{s}.
3898
3899 @quotation
3900 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3901 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3902 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3903 @c distinction here.
3904 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3905 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3906 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3907 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3908 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3909 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3910 below.
3911 @end quotation
3912
3913 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3914 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3915 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3916 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3917 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3918 called within the line.
3919
3920 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3921 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3922 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3923 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3924 was any debugging information about the routine.
3925
3926 @item step @var{count}
3927 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3928 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3929 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3930
3931 @kindex next
3932 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3933 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3934 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3935 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3936 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3937 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3938 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3939 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3940
3941 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3942
3943
3944 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3945 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3946 @c
3947 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3948 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3949 @c function are executed without stopping.
3950
3951 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3952 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3953 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3954
3955 @kindex set step-mode
3956 @item set step-mode
3957 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3958 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3959 @itemx set step-mode on
3960 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3961 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3962 information rather than stepping over it.
3963
3964 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3965 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3966 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3967
3968 @item set step-mode off
3969 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3970 debug information. This is the default.
3971
3972 @item show step-mode
3973 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3974 source line debug information.
3975
3976 @kindex finish
3977 @item finish
3978 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3979 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3980
3981 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3982 ,Returning from a function}).
3983
3984 @kindex until
3985 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3986 @cindex run until specified location
3987 @item until
3988 @itemx u
3989 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3990 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3991 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3992 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3993 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3994 than the address of the jump.
3995
3996 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3997 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3998 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3999 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4000 through the next iteration.
4001
4002 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4003 stack frame.
4004
4005 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4006 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4007 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4008 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4009 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4010
4011 @smallexample
4012 (@value{GDBP}) f
4013 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4014 206 expand_input();
4015 (@value{GDBP}) until
4016 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4017 @end smallexample
4018
4019 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4020 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4021 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4022 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4023 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4024 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4025 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4026
4027 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4028 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4029 argument.
4030
4031 @item until @var{location}
4032 @itemx u @var{location}
4033 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4034 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4035 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4036 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4037 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4038 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4039 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4040 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4041 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4042 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4043 invocations have returned.
4044
4045 @smallexample
4046 94 int factorial (int value)
4047 95 @{
4048 96 if (value > 1) @{
4049 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4050 98 @}
4051 99 return (value);
4052 100 @}
4053 @end smallexample
4054
4055
4056 @kindex advance @var{location}
4057 @itemx advance @var{location}
4058 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4059 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4060 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4061 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4062 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4063 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4064
4065
4066 @kindex stepi
4067 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4068 @item stepi
4069 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4070 @itemx si
4071 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4072
4073 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4074 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4075 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4076 Display,, Automatic display}.
4077
4078 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4079
4080 @need 750
4081 @kindex nexti
4082 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4083 @item nexti
4084 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4085 @itemx ni
4086 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4087 proceed until the function returns.
4088
4089 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4090 @end table
4091
4092 @node Signals
4093 @section Signals
4094 @cindex signals
4095
4096 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4097 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4098 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4099 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
4100 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4101 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4102 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4103 requested an alarm).
4104
4105 @cindex fatal signals
4106 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4107 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4108 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4109 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4110 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4111 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4112
4113 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4114 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4115 signal.
4116
4117 @cindex handling signals
4118 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4119 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4120 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4121 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4122 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4123
4124 @table @code
4125 @kindex info signals
4126 @kindex info handle
4127 @item info signals
4128 @itemx info handle
4129 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4130 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4131 the defined types of signals.
4132
4133 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4134
4135 @kindex handle
4136 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
4137 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4138 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4139 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4140 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4141 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
4142 @end table
4143
4144 @c @group
4145 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4146 Their full names are:
4147
4148 @table @code
4149 @item nostop
4150 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4151 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4152
4153 @item stop
4154 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4155 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4156
4157 @item print
4158 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4159
4160 @item noprint
4161 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4162 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4163
4164 @item pass
4165 @itemx noignore
4166 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4167 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4168 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4169
4170 @item nopass
4171 @itemx ignore
4172 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4173 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4174 @end table
4175 @c @end group
4176
4177 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4178 program until you
4179 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4180 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4181 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4182 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4183 program sees that signal when you continue.
4184
4185 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4186 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4187 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4188 erroneous signals.
4189
4190 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4191 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4192 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4193 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4194 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4195 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4196 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4197 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4198 program a signal}.
4199
4200 @node Thread Stops
4201 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4202
4203 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4204 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4205 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4206
4207 @table @code
4208 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4209 @cindex thread breakpoints
4210 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4211 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4212 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4213 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4214 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4215
4216 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4217 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4218 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4219 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4220 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4221
4222 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4223 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4224 program.
4225
4226 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4227 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4228 breakpoint condition, like this:
4229
4230 @smallexample
4231 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4232 @end smallexample
4233
4234 @end table
4235
4236 @cindex stopped threads
4237 @cindex threads, stopped
4238 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4239 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4240 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4241 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4242 underfoot.
4243
4244 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4245 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4246 @cindex premature return from system calls
4247 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4248 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4249 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4250 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4251 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4252 stop execution.
4253
4254 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4255 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4256 style anyways.
4257
4258 For example, do not write code like this:
4259
4260 @smallexample
4261 sleep (10);
4262 @end smallexample
4263
4264 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4265 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4266
4267 Instead, write this:
4268
4269 @smallexample
4270 int unslept = 10;
4271 while (unslept > 0)
4272 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4273 @end smallexample
4274
4275 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4276 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4277 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4278 @value{GDBN}.
4279
4280 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4281 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4282 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4283 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4284
4285 @cindex continuing threads
4286 @cindex threads, continuing
4287 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4288 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4289 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4290
4291 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4292 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4293 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4294 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4295 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4296 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4297 stops.
4298
4299 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4300 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4301 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4302 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4303
4304 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4305 thread to run.
4306
4307 @table @code
4308 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4309 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4310 @cindex lock scheduler
4311 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4312 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4313 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4314 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4315 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4316 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4317 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4318 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4319 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4320 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4321 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4322
4323 @item show scheduler-locking
4324 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4325 @end table
4326
4327
4328 @node Stack
4329 @chapter Examining the Stack
4330
4331 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4332 stopped and how it got there.
4333
4334 @cindex call stack
4335 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4336 is generated.
4337 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4338 the arguments of the call,
4339 and the local variables of the function being called.
4340 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4341 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4342 stack}.
4343
4344 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4345 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4346
4347 @cindex selected frame
4348 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4349 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4350 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4351 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4352 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4353 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4354
4355 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4356 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4357 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4358
4359 @menu
4360 * Frames:: Stack frames
4361 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4362 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4363 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4364
4365 @end menu
4366
4367 @node Frames
4368 @section Stack frames
4369
4370 @cindex frame, definition
4371 @cindex stack frame
4372 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4373 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4374 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4375 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4376 which the function is executing.
4377
4378 @cindex initial frame
4379 @cindex outermost frame
4380 @cindex innermost frame
4381 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4382 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4383 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4384 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4385 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4386 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4387 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4388 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4389
4390 @cindex frame pointer
4391 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4392 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4393 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4394 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4395 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4396 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4397
4398 @cindex frame number
4399 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4400 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4401 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4402 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4403 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4404
4405 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4406 @c underflow problems.
4407 @cindex frameless execution
4408 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4409 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4410 @smallexample
4411 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4412 @end smallexample
4413 generates functions without a frame.)
4414 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4415 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4416 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4417 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4418 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4419 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4420 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4421
4422 @table @code
4423 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4424 @cindex current stack frame
4425 @item frame @var{args}
4426 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4427 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4428 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4429 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4430
4431 @kindex select-frame
4432 @cindex selecting frame silently
4433 @item select-frame
4434 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4435 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4436 @code{frame}.
4437 @end table
4438
4439 @node Backtrace
4440 @section Backtraces
4441
4442 @cindex traceback
4443 @cindex call stack traces
4444 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4445 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4446 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4447 stack.
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @kindex backtrace
4451 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4452 @item backtrace
4453 @itemx bt
4454 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4455 frames in the stack.
4456
4457 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4458 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4459
4460 @item backtrace @var{n}
4461 @itemx bt @var{n}
4462 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4463
4464 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4465 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4466 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4467
4468 @item backtrace full
4469 Print the values of the local variables also.
4470 @itemx bt full
4471 @end table
4472
4473 @kindex where
4474 @kindex info stack
4475 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4476 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4477
4478 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4479 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4480 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4481 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4482 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4483 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4484 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4485 multi-threaded program.
4486
4487 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4488 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4489 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4490 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4491 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4492 line number.
4493
4494 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4495 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4496
4497 @smallexample
4498 @group
4499 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4500 at builtin.c:993
4501 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4502 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4503 at macro.c:71
4504 (More stack frames follow...)
4505 @end group
4506 @end smallexample
4507
4508 @noindent
4509 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4510 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4511 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4512
4513 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4514 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4515 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4516 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4517 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4518 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4519 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4520 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4521 such a backtrace might look like:
4522
4523 @smallexample
4524 @group
4525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4526 at builtin.c:993
4527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4529 at macro.c:71
4530 (More stack frames follow...)
4531 @end group
4532 @end smallexample
4533
4534 @noindent
4535 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4536 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4537
4538 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4539 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4540 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4541
4542 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4543 @cindex program entry point
4544 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4545 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4546 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4547 @code{main}@footnote{
4548 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4549 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4550 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4551 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4552 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4553 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4554
4555 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4556 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4557
4558 @table @code
4559 @item set backtrace past-main
4560 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4561 @kindex set backtrace
4562 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4563
4564 @item set backtrace past-main off
4565 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4566 default.
4567
4568 @item show backtrace past-main
4569 @kindex show backtrace
4570 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4571
4572 @item set backtrace past-entry
4573 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4574 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4575 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4576 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4577
4578 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4579 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4580 application. This is the default.
4581
4582 @item show backtrace past-entry
4583 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4584
4585 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4586 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4587 @cindex backtrace limit
4588 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4589 unlimited.
4590
4591 @item show backtrace limit
4592 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4593 @end table
4594
4595 @node Selection
4596 @section Selecting a frame
4597
4598 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4599 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4600 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4601 of the stack frame just selected.
4602
4603 @table @code
4604 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4605 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4606 @item frame @var{n}
4607 @itemx f @var{n}
4608 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4609 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4610 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4611 @code{main}.
4612
4613 @item frame @var{addr}
4614 @itemx f @var{addr}
4615 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4616 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4617 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4618 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4619 switches between them.
4620
4621 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4622 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4623
4624 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4625 pointer and a program counter.
4626
4627 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4628 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4629
4630 @kindex up
4631 @item up @var{n}
4632 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4633 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4634 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4635
4636 @kindex down
4637 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4638 @item down @var{n}
4639 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4640 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4641 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4642 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4643 @end table
4644
4645 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4646 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4647 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4648 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4649
4650 @need 1000
4651 For example:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 @group
4655 (@value{GDBP}) up
4656 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4657 at env.c:10
4658 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4659 @end group
4660 @end smallexample
4661
4662 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4663 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4664 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4665 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4666 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4667 for details.
4668
4669 @table @code
4670 @kindex down-silently
4671 @kindex up-silently
4672 @item up-silently @var{n}
4673 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4674 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4675 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4676 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4677 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4678 distracting.
4679 @end table
4680
4681 @node Frame Info
4682 @section Information about a frame
4683
4684 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4685 stack frame.
4686
4687 @table @code
4688 @item frame
4689 @itemx f
4690 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4691 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4692 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4693 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4694 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4695
4696 @kindex info frame
4697 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4698 @item info frame
4699 @itemx info f
4700 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4701 including:
4702
4703 @itemize @bullet
4704 @item
4705 the address of the frame
4706 @item
4707 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4708 @item
4709 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4710 @item
4711 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4712 @item
4713 the address of the frame's arguments
4714 @item
4715 the address of the frame's local variables
4716 @item
4717 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4718 @item
4719 which registers were saved in the frame
4720 @end itemize
4721
4722 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4723 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4724 the usual conventions.
4725
4726 @item info frame @var{addr}
4727 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4728 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4729 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4730 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4731 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4732 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4733
4734 @kindex info args
4735 @item info args
4736 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4737
4738 @item info locals
4739 @kindex info locals
4740 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4741 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4742 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4743
4744 @kindex info catch
4745 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4746 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4747 @item info catch
4748 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4749 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4750 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4751 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4752 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4753
4754 @end table
4755
4756
4757 @node Source
4758 @chapter Examining Source Files
4759
4760 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4761 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4762 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4763 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4764 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4765 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4766 source files by explicit command.
4767
4768 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4769 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4770 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4771
4772 @menu
4773 * List:: Printing source lines
4774 * Edit:: Editing source files
4775 * Search:: Searching source files
4776 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4777 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4778 @end menu
4779
4780 @node List
4781 @section Printing source lines
4782
4783 @kindex list
4784 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4785 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4786 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4787 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4788
4789 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4790
4791 @table @code
4792 @item list @var{linenum}
4793 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4794 current source file.
4795
4796 @item list @var{function}
4797 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4798 @var{function}.
4799
4800 @item list
4801 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4802 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4803 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4804 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4805 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4806
4807 @item list -
4808 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4812 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4813 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4814
4815 @table @code
4816 @kindex set listsize
4817 @item set listsize @var{count}
4818 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4819 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4820
4821 @kindex show listsize
4822 @item show listsize
4823 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4824 @end table
4825
4826 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4827 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4828 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4829 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4830 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4831
4832 @cindex linespec
4833 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4834 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4835 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4836 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4837
4838 @table @code
4839 @item list @var{linespec}
4840 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4841
4842 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4843 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4844 linespecs.
4845
4846 @item list ,@var{last}
4847 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4848
4849 @item list @var{first},
4850 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4851
4852 @item list +
4853 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4854
4855 @item list -
4856 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4857
4858 @item list
4859 As described in the preceding table.
4860 @end table
4861
4862 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4863 kinds of linespec.
4864
4865 @table @code
4866 @item @var{number}
4867 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4868 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4869 the same source file as the first linespec.
4870
4871 @item +@var{offset}
4872 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4873 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4874 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4875 first linespec.
4876
4877 @item -@var{offset}
4878 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4879
4880 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4881 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4882
4883 @item @var{function}
4884 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4885 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4886
4887 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4888 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4889 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4890 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4891 identically named functions in different source files.
4892
4893 @item *@var{address}
4894 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4895 @var{address} may be any expression.
4896 @end table
4897
4898 @node Edit
4899 @section Editing source files
4900 @cindex editing source files
4901
4902 @kindex edit
4903 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4904 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4905 The editing program of your choice
4906 is invoked with the current line set to
4907 the active line in the program.
4908 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4909 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4910
4911 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4912
4913 @table @code
4914 @item edit
4915 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4916
4917 @item edit @var{number}
4918 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4919
4920 @item edit @var{function}
4921 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4922
4923 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4924 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4925
4926 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4927 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4928 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4929 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4930 identically named functions in different source files.
4931
4932 @item edit *@var{address}
4933 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4934 @var{address} may be any expression.
4935 @end table
4936
4937 @subsection Choosing your editor
4938 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4939 @footnote{
4940 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4941 following command-line syntax:
4942 @smallexample
4943 ex +@var{number} file
4944 @end smallexample
4945 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4946 the file where to start editing.}.
4947 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4948 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4949 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4950 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4951 @smallexample
4952 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4953 export EDITOR
4954 gdb @dots{}
4955 @end smallexample
4956 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4957 @smallexample
4958 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4959 gdb @dots{}
4960 @end smallexample
4961
4962 @node Search
4963 @section Searching source files
4964 @cindex searching source files
4965
4966 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4967 regular expression.
4968
4969 @table @code
4970 @kindex search
4971 @kindex forward-search
4972 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4973 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4974 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4975 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4976 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4977 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4978 @code{fo}.
4979
4980 @kindex reverse-search
4981 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4982 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4983 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4984 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4985 this command as @code{rev}.
4986 @end table
4987
4988 @node Source Path
4989 @section Specifying source directories
4990
4991 @cindex source path
4992 @cindex directories for source files
4993 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4994 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4995 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4996 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4997 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4998 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4999 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5000
5001 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5002 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5003 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5004 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5005 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5006 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5007 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5008 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5009 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5010 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5011 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5012
5013 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5014 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5015 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5016 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5017 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5018 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5019
5020 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5021 source files.
5022
5023 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5024 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5025 each line is in the file.
5026
5027 @kindex directory
5028 @kindex dir
5029 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5030 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5031 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5032
5033 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5034 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5035
5036 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5037 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5038 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5039 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5040 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5041 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5042 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5043 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5044 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5045 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5046 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5047 name to look up the sources.
5048
5049 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5050 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5051 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5052 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5053 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5054 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5055 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5056 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5057
5058 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5059 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5060 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5061 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5062 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5063 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5064 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5065
5066 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5067 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5068 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5069 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5070 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5071 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5072 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5073 command.
5074
5075 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5076 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5077 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5078 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5079 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5080 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5081 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5085 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5086 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5087 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5088 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5089 part of absolute file names) or
5090 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5091 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5092
5093 @kindex cdir
5094 @kindex cwd
5095 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5096 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5097 @cindex compilation directory
5098 @cindex current directory
5099 @cindex working directory
5100 @cindex directory, current
5101 @cindex directory, compilation
5102 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5103 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5104 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5105 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5106 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5107 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5108
5109 @item directory
5110 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5111
5112 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5113 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5114
5115 @item show directories
5116 @kindex show directories
5117 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5118
5119 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5120 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5121 @kindex set substitute-path
5122 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5123 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5124 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5125
5126 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5127 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5128
5129 @smallexample
5130 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5131 @end smallexample
5132
5133 @noindent
5134 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5135 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5136 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5137
5138 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5139 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5140 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5141 the substitution.
5142
5143 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5144
5145 @smallexample
5146 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5147 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5148 @end smallexample
5149
5150 @noindent
5151 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5152 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5153 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5154 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5155
5156
5157 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5158 @kindex unset substitute-path
5159 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5160 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5161 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5162
5163 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5164
5165 @item show substitute-path [path]
5166 @kindex show substitute-path
5167 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5168 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5169
5170 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5171 rules.
5172
5173 @end table
5174
5175 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5176 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5177 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5178
5179 @enumerate
5180 @item
5181 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5182
5183 @item
5184 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5185 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5186 directories in one command.
5187 @end enumerate
5188
5189 @node Machine Code
5190 @section Source and machine code
5191 @cindex source line and its code address
5192
5193 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5194 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5195 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5196 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5197 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5198 well as hex.
5199
5200 @table @code
5201 @kindex info line
5202 @item info line @var{linespec}
5203 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5204 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5205 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5206 source lines}).
5207 @end table
5208
5209 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5210 the object code for the first line of function
5211 @code{m4_changequote}:
5212
5213 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5214 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5215 @smallexample
5216 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5217 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5218 @end smallexample
5219
5220 @noindent
5221 @cindex code address and its source line
5222 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5223 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5224 @smallexample
5225 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5226 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5227 @end smallexample
5228
5229 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5230 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5231 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5232 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5233 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5234 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5235 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5236 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5237 variables}).
5238
5239 @table @code
5240 @kindex disassemble
5241 @cindex assembly instructions
5242 @cindex instructions, assembly
5243 @cindex machine instructions
5244 @cindex listing machine instructions
5245 @item disassemble
5246 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5247 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5248 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5249 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5250 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5251 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5252 @end table
5253
5254 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5255 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5256
5257 @smallexample
5258 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5259 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5260 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5261 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5262 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5263 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5264 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5265 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5266 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5267 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5268 End of assembler dump.
5269 @end smallexample
5270
5271 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5272 mnemonics or other syntax.
5273
5274 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5275 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5276 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5277 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5278 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5279
5280 @table @code
5281 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5282 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5283 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5284 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5285 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5286 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5287
5288 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5289 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5290 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5291 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5292
5293 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5294 @item show disassembly-flavor
5295 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5296 @end table
5297
5298
5299 @node Data
5300 @chapter Examining Data
5301
5302 @cindex printing data
5303 @cindex examining data
5304 @kindex print
5305 @kindex inspect
5306 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5307 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5308 @c different window or something like that.
5309 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5310 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5311 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5312 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5313 Different Languages}).
5314
5315 @table @code
5316 @item print @var{expr}
5317 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5318 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5319 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5320 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5321 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5322 formats}.
5323
5324 @item print
5325 @itemx print /@var{f}
5326 @cindex reprint the last value
5327 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5328 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5329 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5330 @end table
5331
5332 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5333 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5334 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5335
5336 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5337 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5338 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5339 Table}.
5340
5341 @menu
5342 * Expressions:: Expressions
5343 * Variables:: Program variables
5344 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5345 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5346 * Memory:: Examining memory
5347 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5348 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5349 * Value History:: Value history
5350 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5351 * Registers:: Registers
5352 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5353 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5354 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5355 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5356 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5357 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5358 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5359 character set than GDB does
5360 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5361 @end menu
5362
5363 @node Expressions
5364 @section Expressions
5365
5366 @cindex expressions
5367 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5368 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5369 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5370 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5371 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5372 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5373 @ref{Compilation}.
5374
5375 @cindex arrays in expressions
5376 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5377 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5378 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5379 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5380
5381 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5382 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5383 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5384 languages.
5385
5386 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5387 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5388
5389 @cindex casts, in expressions
5390 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5391 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5392 at that address in memory.
5393 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5394
5395 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5396 to programming languages:
5397
5398 @table @code
5399 @item @@
5400 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5401 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5402
5403 @item ::
5404 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5405 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5406
5407 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5408 @cindex type casting memory
5409 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5410 @cindex casts, to view memory
5411 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5412 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5413 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5414 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5415 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5416 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5417 @end table
5418
5419 @node Variables
5420 @section Program variables
5421
5422 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5423 in your program.
5424
5425 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5426 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5427
5428 @itemize @bullet
5429 @item
5430 global (or file-static)
5431 @end itemize
5432
5433 @noindent or
5434
5435 @itemize @bullet
5436 @item
5437 visible according to the scope rules of the
5438 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5439 @end itemize
5440
5441 @noindent This means that in the function
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 foo (a)
5445 int a;
5446 @{
5447 bar (a);
5448 @{
5449 int b = test ();
5450 bar (b);
5451 @}
5452 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5457 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5458 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5459 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5460
5461 @cindex variable name conflict
5462 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5463 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5464 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5465 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5466 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5467 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5468 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5469
5470 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5471 @iftex
5472 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5473 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5474 @end iftex
5475 @smallexample
5476 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5477 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5478 @end smallexample
5479
5480 @noindent
5481 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5482 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5483 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5484 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5485
5486 @smallexample
5487 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5488 @end smallexample
5489
5490 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5491 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5492 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5493 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5494 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5495 @c conflict?? --mew
5496
5497 @cindex wrong values
5498 @cindex variable values, wrong
5499 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5500 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5501 @quotation
5502 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5503 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5504 scope, and just before exit.
5505 @end quotation
5506 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5507 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5508 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5509 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5510 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5511 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5512 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5513 variable definitions may be gone.
5514
5515 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5516 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5517 when compiling.
5518
5519 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5520 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5521 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5522 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5523 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5524 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5525 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5526
5527 @smallexample
5528 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5529 @end smallexample
5530
5531 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5532 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5533 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5534 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5535 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5536 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5537 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5538 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5539 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5540 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5541
5542 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5543 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5544 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5545 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5546
5547 @node Arrays
5548 @section Artificial arrays
5549
5550 @cindex artificial array
5551 @cindex arrays
5552 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5553 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5554 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5555 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5556 program.
5557
5558 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5559 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5560 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5561 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5562 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5563 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5564 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5565 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5566 example. If a program says
5567
5568 @smallexample
5569 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5570 @end smallexample
5571
5572 @noindent
5573 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5574
5575 @smallexample
5576 p *array@@len
5577 @end smallexample
5578
5579 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5580 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5581 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5582 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5583 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5584
5585 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5586 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5587 The value need not be in memory:
5588 @smallexample
5589 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5590 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5591 @end smallexample
5592
5593 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5594 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5595 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5596 @smallexample
5597 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5598 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5599 @end smallexample
5600
5601 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5602 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5603 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5604 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5605 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5606 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5607 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5608 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5609 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5610 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 set $i = 0
5614 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5615 @key{RET}
5616 @key{RET}
5617 @dots{}
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 @node Output Formats
5621 @section Output formats
5622
5623 @cindex formatted output
5624 @cindex output formats
5625 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5626 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5627 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5628 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5629 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5630
5631 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5632 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5633 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5634 letters supported are:
5635
5636 @table @code
5637 @item x
5638 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5639 hexadecimal.
5640
5641 @item d
5642 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5643
5644 @item u
5645 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5646
5647 @item o
5648 Print as integer in octal.
5649
5650 @item t
5651 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5652 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5653 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5654 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5655
5656 @item a
5657 @cindex unknown address, locating
5658 @cindex locate address
5659 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5660 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5661 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5662
5663 @smallexample
5664 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5665 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5666 @end smallexample
5667
5668 @noindent
5669 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5670 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5671
5672 @item c
5673 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5674 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5675 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5676 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5677
5678 @item f
5679 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5680 using typical floating point syntax.
5681 @end table
5682
5683 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5684
5685 @smallexample
5686 p/x $pc
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 @noindent
5690 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5691 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5692
5693 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5694 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5695 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5696
5697 @node Memory
5698 @section Examining memory
5699
5700 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5701 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5702
5703 @cindex examining memory
5704 @table @code
5705 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5706 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5707 @itemx x @var{addr}
5708 @itemx x
5709 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5710 @end table
5711
5712 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5713 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5714 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5715 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5716 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5717
5718 @table @r
5719 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5720 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5721 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5722 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5723 @c 4.1.2.
5724
5725 @item @var{f}, the display format
5726 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5727 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5728 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5729 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5730 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5731 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5732
5733 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5734 The unit size is any of
5735
5736 @table @code
5737 @item b
5738 Bytes.
5739 @item h
5740 Halfwords (two bytes).
5741 @item w
5742 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5743 @item g
5744 Giant words (eight bytes).
5745 @end table
5746
5747 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5748 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5749 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5750
5751 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5752 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5753 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5754 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5755 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5756 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5757 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5758 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5759 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5760 a value from memory).
5761 @end table
5762
5763 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5764 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5765 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5766 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5767 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5768
5769 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5770 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5771 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5772 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5773 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5774
5775 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5776 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5777 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5778 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5779 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5780 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5781
5782 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5783 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5784 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5785 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5786 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5787 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5788 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5789
5790 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5791 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5792 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5793 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5794 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5795 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5796 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5797 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5798 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5799
5800 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5801 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5802 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5803
5804 @cindex remote memory comparison
5805 @cindex verify remote memory image
5806 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5807 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5808 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5809 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5810 situations.
5811
5812 @table @code
5813 @kindex compare-sections
5814 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5815 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5816 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5817 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5818 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5819 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5820 remote request.
5821 @end table
5822
5823 @node Auto Display
5824 @section Automatic display
5825 @cindex automatic display
5826 @cindex display of expressions
5827
5828 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5829 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5830 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5831 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5832 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5833 The automatic display looks like this:
5834
5835 @smallexample
5836 2: foo = 38
5837 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5838 @end smallexample
5839
5840 @noindent
5841 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5842 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5843 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5844 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5845 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5846 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5847 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5848
5849 @table @code
5850 @kindex display
5851 @item display @var{expr}
5852 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5853 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5854
5855 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5856
5857 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5858 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5859 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5860 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5861 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5862
5863 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5864 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5865 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5866 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5867 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5868 @end table
5869
5870 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5871 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5872 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5873
5874 @table @code
5875 @kindex delete display
5876 @kindex undisplay
5877 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5878 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5879 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5880
5881 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5882 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5883
5884 @kindex disable display
5885 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5886 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5887 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5888 enabled again later.
5889
5890 @kindex enable display
5891 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5892 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5893 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5894
5895 @item display
5896 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5897 done when your program stops.
5898
5899 @kindex info display
5900 @item info display
5901 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5902 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5903 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5904 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5905 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5906 @end table
5907
5908 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5909 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5910 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5911 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5912 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5913 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5914 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5915 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5916 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5917 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5918 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5919
5920 @node Print Settings
5921 @section Print settings
5922
5923 @cindex format options
5924 @cindex print settings
5925 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5926 and symbols are printed.
5927
5928 @noindent
5929 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5930
5931 @table @code
5932 @kindex set print
5933 @item set print address
5934 @itemx set print address on
5935 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5936 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5937 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5938 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5939 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5940 @code{set print address on}:
5941
5942 @smallexample
5943 @group
5944 (@value{GDBP}) f
5945 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5946 at input.c:530
5947 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5948 @end group
5949 @end smallexample
5950
5951 @item set print address off
5952 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5953 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5954
5955 @smallexample
5956 @group
5957 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5958 (@value{GDBP}) f
5959 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5960 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5961 @end group
5962 @end smallexample
5963
5964 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5965 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5966 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5967 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5968
5969 @kindex show print
5970 @item show print address
5971 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5975 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5976 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5977 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5978 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5979 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5980 it prints a symbolic address:
5981
5982 @table @code
5983 @item set print symbol-filename on
5984 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5985 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5986 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5987 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5988
5989 @item set print symbol-filename off
5990 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5991 default.
5992
5993 @item show print symbol-filename
5994 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5995 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5996 @end table
5997
5998 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5999 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6000 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6001
6002 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6003 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6004
6005 @table @code
6006 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6007 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6008 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6009 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6010 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6011 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6012
6013 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6014 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6015 symbolic address.
6016 @end table
6017
6018 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6019 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6020 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6021 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6022 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6023 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6024 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6025 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6026
6027 @smallexample
6028 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6029 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6030 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6031 @end smallexample
6032
6033 @quotation
6034 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6035 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6036 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6037 @end quotation
6038
6039 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6040
6041 @table @code
6042 @item set print array
6043 @itemx set print array on
6044 @cindex pretty print arrays
6045 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6046 but uses more space. The default is off.
6047
6048 @item set print array off
6049 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6050
6051 @item show print array
6052 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6053 arrays.
6054
6055 @cindex print array indexes
6056 @item set print array-indexes
6057 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6058 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6059 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6060 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6061
6062 @item set print array-indexes off
6063 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6064
6065 @item show print array-indexes
6066 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6067 arrays.
6068
6069 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6070 @cindex number of array elements to print
6071 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6072 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6073 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6074 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6075 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6076 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6077 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6078
6079 @item show print elements
6080 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6081 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6082
6083 @item set print repeats
6084 @cindex repeated array elements
6085 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6086 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6087 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6088 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6089 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6090 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6091 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6092
6093 @item show print repeats
6094 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6095 elements.
6096
6097 @item set print null-stop
6098 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6099 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6100 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6101 contain only short strings.
6102 The default is off.
6103
6104 @item show print null-stop
6105 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6106 @sc{null} character.
6107
6108 @item set print pretty on
6109 @cindex print structures in indented form
6110 @cindex indentation in structure display
6111 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6112 per line, like this:
6113
6114 @smallexample
6115 @group
6116 $1 = @{
6117 next = 0x0,
6118 flags = @{
6119 sweet = 1,
6120 sour = 1
6121 @},
6122 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6123 @}
6124 @end group
6125 @end smallexample
6126
6127 @item set print pretty off
6128 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6129
6130 @smallexample
6131 @group
6132 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6133 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 @noindent
6138 This is the default format.
6139
6140 @item show print pretty
6141 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6142
6143 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6144 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6145 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6146 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6147 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6148 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6149 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6150 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6151
6152 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6153 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6154 international character sets, and is the default.
6155
6156 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6157 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6158
6159 @item set print union on
6160 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6161 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6162 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6163
6164 @item set print union off
6165 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6166 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6167 instead.
6168
6169 @item show print union
6170 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6171 structures and other unions.
6172
6173 For example, given the declarations
6174
6175 @smallexample
6176 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6177 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6178 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6179 Bug_forms;
6180
6181 struct thing @{
6182 Species it;
6183 union @{
6184 Tree_forms tree;
6185 Bug_forms bug;
6186 @} form;
6187 @};
6188
6189 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6190 @end smallexample
6191
6192 @noindent
6193 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6194
6195 @smallexample
6196 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6197 @end smallexample
6198
6199 @noindent
6200 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6201
6202 @smallexample
6203 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 @noindent
6207 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6208 and in Pascal.
6209 @end table
6210
6211 @need 1000
6212 @noindent
6213 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6214
6215 @table @code
6216 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6217 @item set print demangle
6218 @itemx set print demangle on
6219 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6220 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6221 linkage. The default is on.
6222
6223 @item show print demangle
6224 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6225
6226 @item set print asm-demangle
6227 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6228 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6229 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6230 The default is off.
6231
6232 @item show print asm-demangle
6233 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6234 or demangled form.
6235
6236 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6237 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6238 @kindex set demangle-style
6239 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6240 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6241 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6242
6243 @table @code
6244 @item auto
6245 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6246
6247 @item gnu
6248 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6249 This is the default.
6250
6251 @item hp
6252 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6253
6254 @item lucid
6255 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6256
6257 @item arm
6258 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6259 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6260 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6261 require further enhancement to permit that.
6262
6263 @end table
6264 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6265
6266 @item show demangle-style
6267 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6268
6269 @item set print object
6270 @itemx set print object on
6271 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6272 @cindex display derived types
6273 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6274 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6275 the virtual function table.
6276
6277 @item set print object off
6278 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6279 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6280
6281 @item show print object
6282 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6283
6284 @item set print static-members
6285 @itemx set print static-members on
6286 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6287 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6288
6289 @item set print static-members off
6290 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6291
6292 @item show print static-members
6293 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6294
6295 @item set print pascal_static-members
6296 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6297 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6298 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6299 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6300
6301 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6302 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6303
6304 @item show print pascal_static-members
6305 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6306
6307 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6308 @item set print vtbl
6309 @itemx set print vtbl on
6310 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6311 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6312 @cindex VTBL display
6313 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6314 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6315 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6316
6317 @item set print vtbl off
6318 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6319
6320 @item show print vtbl
6321 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6322 @end table
6323
6324 @node Value History
6325 @section Value history
6326
6327 @cindex value history
6328 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6329 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6330 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6331 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6332 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6333 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6334 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6335 symbol table.
6336
6337 @cindex @code{$}
6338 @cindex @code{$$}
6339 @cindex history number
6340 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6341 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6342 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6343 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6344 history number.
6345
6346 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6347 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6348 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6349 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6350 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6351 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6352 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6353
6354 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6355 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6356
6357 @smallexample
6358 p *$
6359 @end smallexample
6360
6361 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6362 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6363
6364 @smallexample
6365 p *$.next
6366 @end smallexample
6367
6368 @noindent
6369 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6370 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6371
6372 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6373 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6374
6375 @smallexample
6376 print x
6377 set x=5
6378 @end smallexample
6379
6380 @noindent
6381 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6382 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6383
6384 @table @code
6385 @kindex show values
6386 @item show values
6387 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6388 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6389 values} does not change the history.
6390
6391 @item show values @var{n}
6392 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6393
6394 @item show values +
6395 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6396 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6397 @end table
6398
6399 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6400 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6401
6402 @node Convenience Vars
6403 @section Convenience variables
6404
6405 @cindex convenience variables
6406 @cindex user-defined variables
6407 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6408 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6409 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6410 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6411 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6412
6413 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6414 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6415 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6416 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6417 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6418
6419 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6420 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6421 For example:
6422
6423 @smallexample
6424 set $foo = *object_ptr
6425 @end smallexample
6426
6427 @noindent
6428 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6429 @code{object_ptr}.
6430
6431 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6432 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6433 value with another assignment at any time.
6434
6435 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6436 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6437 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6438 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6439
6440 @table @code
6441 @kindex show convenience
6442 @cindex show all user variables
6443 @item show convenience
6444 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6445 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6446
6447 @kindex init-if-undefined
6448 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6449 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6450 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6451 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6452 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6453 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6454 override default values used in a command script.
6455
6456 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6457 any side-effects do not occur.
6458 @end table
6459
6460 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6461 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6462 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6463
6464 @smallexample
6465 set $i = 0
6466 print bar[$i++]->contents
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 @noindent
6470 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6471
6472 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6473 values likely to be useful.
6474
6475 @table @code
6476 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6477 @item $_
6478 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6479 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6480 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6481 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6482 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6483 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6484 to the type of @code{$__}.
6485
6486 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6487 @item $__
6488 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6489 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6490 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6491
6492 @item $_exitcode
6493 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6494 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6495 the program being debugged terminates.
6496 @end table
6497
6498 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6499 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6500 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6501
6502 @node Registers
6503 @section Registers
6504
6505 @cindex registers
6506 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6507 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6508 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6509 your machine.
6510
6511 @table @code
6512 @kindex info registers
6513 @item info registers
6514 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6515 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6516
6517 @kindex info all-registers
6518 @cindex floating point registers
6519 @item info all-registers
6520 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6521 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6522
6523 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6524 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6525 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6526 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6527 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6528 @end table
6529
6530 @cindex stack pointer register
6531 @cindex program counter register
6532 @cindex process status register
6533 @cindex frame pointer register
6534 @cindex standard registers
6535 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6536 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6537 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6538 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6539 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6540 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6541 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6542 you could print the program counter in hex with
6543
6544 @smallexample
6545 p/x $pc
6546 @end smallexample
6547
6548 @noindent
6549 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6550
6551 @smallexample
6552 x/i $pc
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 @noindent
6556 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6557 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6558 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6559 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6560 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6561 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6562 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6563
6564 @smallexample
6565 set $sp += 4
6566 @end smallexample
6567
6568 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6569 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6570 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6571 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6572 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6573 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6574 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6575
6576 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6577 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6578 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6579 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6580 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6581 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6582 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6583
6584 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6585 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6586 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6587 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6588 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6589 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6590 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6591 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6592 prints the data in both formats.
6593
6594 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6595 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6596 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6597 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6598 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6599 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6600 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6601
6602 @smallexample
6603 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6604 $1 = @{
6605 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6606 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6607 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6608 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6609 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6610 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6611 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6612 @}
6613 @end smallexample
6614
6615 @noindent
6616 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6617 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6618 value to a @code{struct} member:
6619
6620 @smallexample
6621 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6622 @end smallexample
6623
6624 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6625 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6626 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6627 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6628 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6629 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6630
6631 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6632 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6633 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6634 frame makes no difference.
6635
6636 @node Floating Point Hardware
6637 @section Floating point hardware
6638 @cindex floating point
6639
6640 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6641 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6642
6643 @table @code
6644 @kindex info float
6645 @item info float
6646 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6647 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6648 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6649 the ARM and x86 machines.
6650 @end table
6651
6652 @node Vector Unit
6653 @section Vector Unit
6654 @cindex vector unit
6655
6656 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6657 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6658
6659 @table @code
6660 @kindex info vector
6661 @item info vector
6662 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6663 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6664 @end table
6665
6666 @node OS Information
6667 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6668 @cindex OS information
6669
6670 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6671 you debug your program.
6672
6673 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6674 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6675 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6676 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6677 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6678 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6679 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6680 structure.
6681
6682 @table @code
6683 @item info udot
6684 @kindex info udot
6685 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6686 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6687 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6688 the @code{examine} command.
6689 @end table
6690
6691 @cindex auxiliary vector
6692 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6693 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6694 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6695 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6696 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6697 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6698 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6699 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6700 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6701 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6702 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6703 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6704
6705 @table @code
6706 @kindex info auxv
6707 @item info auxv
6708 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6709 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6710 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6711 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6712 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6713 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6714 an unrecognized tag.
6715 @end table
6716
6717
6718 @node Memory Region Attributes
6719 @section Memory region attributes
6720 @cindex memory region attributes
6721
6722 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6723 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6724 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6725 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6726 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6727 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6728 user can override the fetched regions.
6729
6730 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6731 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6732 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6733 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6734 all memory.
6735
6736 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6737 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6738
6739 @table @code
6740 @kindex mem
6741 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6742 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6743 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6744 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6745 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6746 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6747
6748 @item mem auto
6749 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6750 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6751
6752 @kindex delete mem
6753 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6754 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6755 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6756
6757 @kindex disable mem
6758 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6759 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6760 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6761 It may be enabled again later.
6762
6763 @kindex enable mem
6764 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6765 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6766
6767 @kindex info mem
6768 @item info mem
6769 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6770 for each region:
6771
6772 @table @emph
6773 @item Memory Region Number
6774 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6775 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6776 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6777
6778 @item Lo Address
6779 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6780
6781 @item Hi Address
6782 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6783
6784 @item Attributes
6785 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6786 @end table
6787 @end table
6788
6789
6790 @subsection Attributes
6791
6792 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6793 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6794 write accesses to a memory region.
6795
6796 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6797 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6798 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6799
6800 @table @code
6801 @item ro
6802 Memory is read only.
6803 @item wo
6804 Memory is write only.
6805 @item rw
6806 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6807 @end table
6808
6809 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6810 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6811 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6812 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6813 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @item 8
6817 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6818 @item 16
6819 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6820 @item 32
6821 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6822 @item 64
6823 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6824 @end table
6825
6826 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6827 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6828 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6829 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6830 @c
6831 @c @table @code
6832 @c @item hwbreak
6833 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6834 @c @item swbreak (default)
6835 @c @end table
6836
6837 @subsubsection Data Cache
6838 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6839 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6840 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6841 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6842 registers.
6843
6844 @table @code
6845 @item cache
6846 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6847 @item nocache
6848 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6854 @c
6855 @c @table @code
6856 @c @item verify
6857 @c @item noverify (default)
6858 @c @end table
6859
6860 @node Dump/Restore Files
6861 @section Copy between memory and a file
6862 @cindex dump/restore files
6863 @cindex append data to a file
6864 @cindex dump data to a file
6865 @cindex restore data from a file
6866
6867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6872 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6873 files.
6874
6875 @table @code
6876
6877 @kindex dump
6878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6882
6883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6884 @table @code
6885 @item binary
6886 Raw binary form.
6887 @item ihex
6888 Intel hex format.
6889 @item srec
6890 Motorola S-record format.
6891 @item tekhex
6892 Tektronix Hex format.
6893 @end table
6894
6895 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6896 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6897 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6898 form.
6899
6900 @kindex append
6901 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6902 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6903 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6904 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6905 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6906
6907 @kindex restore
6908 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6909 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6910 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6911 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6912 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6913
6914 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6915 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6916 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6917 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6918 from that location.
6919
6920 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6921 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6922 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6923 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6924
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @node Core File Generation
6928 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6929 @cindex dump core from inferior
6930
6931 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6932 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6933 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6934 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6935 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6936 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6937 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6938
6939 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6940 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6941 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6942
6943 @table @code
6944 @kindex gcore
6945 @kindex generate-core-file
6946 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6947 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6948 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6949 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6950 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6951 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6952
6953 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6954 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6955 @end table
6956
6957 @node Character Sets
6958 @section Character Sets
6959 @cindex character sets
6960 @cindex charset
6961 @cindex translating between character sets
6962 @cindex host character set
6963 @cindex target character set
6964
6965 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6966 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6967 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6968 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6969 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6970 @dfn{target character set}.
6971
6972 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6973 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6974 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6975 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6976 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6977 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6978 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6979 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6980 character and string literals in expressions.
6981
6982 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6983 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6984 target-charset} command, described below.
6985
6986 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6987 support:
6988
6989 @table @code
6990 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6991 @kindex set target-charset
6992 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6993 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6994 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6995 list the target character sets it supports.
6996 @end table
6997
6998 @table @code
6999 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7000 @kindex set host-charset
7001 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7002
7003 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7004 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7005 @code{set host-charset} command.
7006
7007 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7008 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7009 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7010 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7011 list the host character sets it supports.
7012
7013 @item set charset @var{charset}
7014 @kindex set charset
7015 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7016 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7017 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7018 for both host and target.
7019
7020
7021 @item show charset
7022 @kindex show charset
7023 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7024
7025 @itemx show host-charset
7026 @kindex show host-charset
7027 Show the name of the current host charset.
7028
7029 @itemx show target-charset
7030 @kindex show target-charset
7031 Show the name of the current target charset.
7032
7033 @end table
7034
7035 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7036 sets:
7037
7038 @table @code
7039
7040 @item ASCII
7041 @cindex ASCII character set
7042 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7043 character set.
7044
7045 @item ISO-8859-1
7046 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7047 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7048 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7049 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7050 this as its host character set.
7051
7052 @item EBCDIC-US
7053 @itemx IBM1047
7054 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7055 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7056 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7057 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7058 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7059
7060 @end table
7061
7062 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7063 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7064 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7065
7066 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7067 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7068 @file{charset-test.c}:
7069
7070 @smallexample
7071 #include <stdio.h>
7072
7073 char ascii_hello[]
7074 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7075 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7076 char ibm1047_hello[]
7077 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7078 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7079
7080 main ()
7081 @{
7082 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7083 @}
7084 @end smallexample
7085
7086 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7087 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7088 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7089
7090 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7091
7092 @smallexample
7093 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7094 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7095 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7096 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7097 @dots{}
7098 (@value{GDBP})
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7102 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7103 strings:
7104
7105 @smallexample
7106 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7107 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7108 (@value{GDBP})
7109 @end smallexample
7110
7111 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7112 initial character set:
7113 @smallexample
7114 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7115 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7116 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7117 (@value{GDBP})
7118 @end smallexample
7119
7120 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7121 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7122 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7123 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7124 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7125
7126 @smallexample
7127 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7128 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7129 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7130 $2 = 72 'H'
7131 (@value{GDBP})
7132 @end smallexample
7133
7134 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7135 literals you use in expressions:
7136
7137 @smallexample
7138 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7139 $3 = 43 '+'
7140 (@value{GDBP})
7141 @end smallexample
7142
7143 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7144 character.
7145
7146 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7147 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7148 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7149
7150 @smallexample
7151 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7152 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7153 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7154 $5 = 200 '\310'
7155 (@value{GDBP})
7156 @end smallexample
7157
7158 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7159 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7160
7161 @smallexample
7162 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7163 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7164 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7165 @end smallexample
7166
7167 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7168 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7169 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7170 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7171 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7172
7173 @smallexample
7174 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7175 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7176 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7177 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7178 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7179 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7180 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7181 $7 = 72 '\110'
7182 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7183 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7184 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7185 $9 = 200 'H'
7186 (@value{GDBP})
7187 @end smallexample
7188
7189 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7190 string literals you use in expressions:
7191
7192 @smallexample
7193 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7194 $10 = 78 '+'
7195 (@value{GDBP})
7196 @end smallexample
7197
7198 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7199 character.
7200
7201 @node Caching Remote Data
7202 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7203 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7204
7205 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7206 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7207 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7208 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7209 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7210 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7211 volatile registers are in use.
7212
7213 @table @code
7214 @kindex set remotecache
7215 @item set remotecache on
7216 @itemx set remotecache off
7217 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7218 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7219
7220 @kindex show remotecache
7221 @item show remotecache
7222 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7223
7224 @kindex info dcache
7225 @item info dcache
7226 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7227 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7228 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7229 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7230 the data cache operation.
7231 @end table
7232
7233
7234 @node Macros
7235 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7236
7237 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7238 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7239 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7240 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7241 where it was defined.
7242
7243 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7244 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7245 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7246 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7247
7248 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7249 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7250 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7251 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7252 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7253 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7254 see @ref{List}.
7255
7256 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7257 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7258 variable-arity macros.
7259
7260 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7261 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7262 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7263
7264 @table @code
7265
7266 @kindex macro expand
7267 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7268 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7269 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7270 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7271 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7272 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7273 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7274 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7275 it can be any string of tokens.
7276
7277 @kindex macro exp1
7278 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7279 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7280 @cindex expand macro once
7281 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7282 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7283 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7284 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7285 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7286 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7287 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7288 can be any string of tokens.
7289
7290 @kindex info macro
7291 @cindex macro definition, showing
7292 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7293 @item info macro @var{macro}
7294 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7295 source location where that definition was established.
7296
7297 @kindex macro define
7298 @cindex user-defined macros
7299 @cindex defining macros interactively
7300 @cindex macros, user-defined
7301 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7302 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7303 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7304 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7305 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7306 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7307 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7308 given in @var{arglist}.
7309
7310 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7311 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7312 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7313 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7314 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7315
7316 @kindex macro undef
7317 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7318 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7319 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7320 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7321 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7322 debugged.
7323
7324 @kindex macro list
7325 @item macro list
7326 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7327 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7328 @end table
7329
7330 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7331 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7332 show our source files:
7333
7334 @smallexample
7335 $ cat sample.c
7336 #include <stdio.h>
7337 #include "sample.h"
7338
7339 #define M 42
7340 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7341
7342 main ()
7343 @{
7344 #define N 28
7345 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7346 #undef N
7347 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7348 #define N 1729
7349 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7350 @}
7351 $ cat sample.h
7352 #define Q <
7353 $
7354 @end smallexample
7355
7356 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7357 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7358 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7359 information.
7360
7361 @smallexample
7362 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7363 $
7364 @end smallexample
7365
7366 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7367
7368 @smallexample
7369 $ gdb -nw sample
7370 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7371 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7372 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7373 (@value{GDBP})
7374 @end smallexample
7375
7376 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7377 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7378 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7379
7380 @smallexample
7381 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7382 3
7383 4 #define M 42
7384 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7385 6
7386 7 main ()
7387 8 @{
7388 9 #define N 28
7389 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7390 11 #undef N
7391 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7392 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7393 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7394 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7395 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7396 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7397 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7398 #define Q <
7399 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7400 expands to: (42 + 1)
7401 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7402 expands to: once (M + 1)
7403 (@value{GDBP})
7404 @end smallexample
7405
7406 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7407 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7408 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7409 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7410
7411 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7412 the source line of the current stack frame:
7413
7414 @smallexample
7415 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7416 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7417 (@value{GDBP}) run
7418 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7419
7420 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7421 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7422 (@value{GDBP})
7423 @end smallexample
7424
7425 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7429 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7430 #define N 28
7431 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7432 expands to: 28 < 42
7433 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7434 $1 = 1
7435 (@value{GDBP})
7436 @end smallexample
7437
7438 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7439 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7440 thereof) in force at each point:
7441
7442 @smallexample
7443 (@value{GDBP}) next
7444 Hello, world!
7445 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7446 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7447 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7448 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7449 (@value{GDBP}) next
7450 We're so creative.
7451 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7452 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7453 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7454 #define N 1729
7455 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7456 expands to: 1729 < 42
7457 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7458 $2 = 0
7459 (@value{GDBP})
7460 @end smallexample
7461
7462
7463 @node Tracepoints
7464 @chapter Tracepoints
7465 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7466 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7467
7468 @cindex tracepoints
7469 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7470 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7471 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7472 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7473 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7474 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7475 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7476
7477 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7478 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7479 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7480 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7481 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7482 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7483 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7484 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7485 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7486 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7487 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7488
7489 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7490 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7491 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7492 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7493 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7494 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7495 Packets}.
7496
7497 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7498
7499 @menu
7500 * Set Tracepoints::
7501 * Analyze Collected Data::
7502 * Tracepoint Variables::
7503 @end menu
7504
7505 @node Set Tracepoints
7506 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7507
7508 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7509 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7510 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7511 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7512 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7513 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7514 work on.
7515
7516 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7517 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7518 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7519 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7520 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7521 tracepoint was hit.
7522
7523 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7524 conditions and actions.
7525
7526 @menu
7527 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7528 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7529 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7530 * Tracepoint Actions::
7531 * Listing Tracepoints::
7532 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7533 @end menu
7534
7535 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7536 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7537
7538 @table @code
7539 @cindex set tracepoint
7540 @kindex trace
7541 @item trace
7542 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7543 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7544 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7545 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7546 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7547 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7548 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7549 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7550 running.
7551
7552 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7553
7554 @smallexample
7555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7556
7557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7558
7559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7560
7561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7562
7563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7564 @end smallexample
7565
7566 @noindent
7567 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7568
7569 @vindex $tpnum
7570 @cindex last tracepoint number
7571 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7572 @cindex tracepoint number
7573 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7574 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7575
7576 @kindex delete tracepoint
7577 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7578 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7579 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7580 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7581
7582 Examples:
7583
7584 @smallexample
7585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7586
7587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7588 @end smallexample
7589
7590 @noindent
7591 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7592 @end table
7593
7594 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7595 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7596
7597 @table @code
7598 @kindex disable tracepoint
7599 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7600 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7601 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7602 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7603 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7604
7605 @kindex enable tracepoint
7606 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7607 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7608 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7609 run.
7610 @end table
7611
7612 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7613 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7614
7615 @table @code
7616 @kindex passcount
7617 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7618 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7619 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7620 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7621 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7622 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7623 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7624 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7625 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7626 user.
7627
7628 Examples:
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7632 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7633
7634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7635 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7642 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7643 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7644 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7645 @end smallexample
7646 @end table
7647
7648 @node Tracepoint Actions
7649 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7650
7651 @table @code
7652 @kindex actions
7653 @cindex tracepoint actions
7654 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7655 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7656 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7657 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7658 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7659 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7660 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7661 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7662 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7663 @code{while-stepping}.
7664
7665 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7666 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7667 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7668
7669 @smallexample
7670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7671
7672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7673
7674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7678 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7679 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7680 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7681 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7682 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7683 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7684 @code{end} command.
7685
7686 @smallexample
7687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7689 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7690 > collect bar,baz
7691 > collect $regs
7692 > while-stepping 12
7693 > collect $fp, $sp
7694 > end
7695 end
7696 @end smallexample
7697
7698 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7699 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7700 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7701 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7702 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7703 special arguments are supported:
7704
7705 @table @code
7706 @item $regs
7707 collect all registers
7708
7709 @item $args
7710 collect all function arguments
7711
7712 @item $locals
7713 collect all local variables.
7714 @end table
7715
7716 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7717 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7718 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7719
7720 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7721 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7722
7723 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7724 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7725 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7726 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7727 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7728 its own @code{end} command):
7729
7730 @smallexample
7731 > while-stepping 12
7732 > collect $regs, myglobal
7733 > end
7734 >
7735 @end smallexample
7736
7737 @noindent
7738 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7739 @code{stepping}.
7740 @end table
7741
7742 @node Listing Tracepoints
7743 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7744
7745 @table @code
7746 @kindex info tracepoints
7747 @kindex info tp
7748 @cindex information about tracepoints
7749 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7750 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7751 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7752 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7753 shown:
7754
7755 @itemize @bullet
7756 @item
7757 its number
7758 @item
7759 whether it is enabled or disabled
7760 @item
7761 its address
7762 @item
7763 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7764 @item
7765 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7766 @item
7767 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7768 @item
7769 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7770 @end itemize
7771
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7774 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7775 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7776 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7777 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7778 (@value{GDBP})
7779 @end smallexample
7780
7781 @noindent
7782 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7783 @end table
7784
7785 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7786 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7787
7788 @table @code
7789 @kindex tstart
7790 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7791 @cindex collected data discarded
7792 @item tstart
7793 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7794 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7795 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7796 experiment.
7797
7798 @kindex tstop
7799 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7800 @item tstop
7801 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7802 stops collecting data.
7803
7804 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7805 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7806 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7807
7808 @kindex tstatus
7809 @cindex status of trace data collection
7810 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7811 @item tstatus
7812 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7813 collection.
7814 @end table
7815
7816 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7817
7818 @smallexample
7819 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7821 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7822 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7823 > while-stepping 11
7824 > collect $regs
7825 > end
7826 > end
7827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7828 [time passes @dots{}]
7829 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7830 @end smallexample
7831
7832
7833 @node Analyze Collected Data
7834 @section Using the collected data
7835
7836 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7837 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7838 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7839 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7840 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7841 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7842 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7843 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7844 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7845 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7846 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7847 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7848 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7849 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7850 the buffer will fail.
7851
7852 @menu
7853 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7854 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7855 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7856 @end menu
7857
7858 @node tfind
7859 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7860
7861 @kindex tfind
7862 @cindex select trace snapshot
7863 @cindex find trace snapshot
7864 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7865 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7866 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7867 snapshot is selected.
7868
7869 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7870
7871 @table @code
7872 @item tfind start
7873 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7874 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7875
7876 @item tfind none
7877 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7878
7879 @item tfind end
7880 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7881
7882 @item tfind
7883 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7884
7885 @item tfind -
7886 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7887 retracing earlier steps.
7888
7889 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7890 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7891 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7892 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7893 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7894
7895 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7896 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7897 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7898 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7899 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7900
7901 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7902 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7903 addresses.
7904
7905 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7906 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7907 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7908
7909 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7910 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7911 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7912 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7913 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7914 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7915 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7916 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7917 @end table
7918
7919 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7920 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7921 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7922 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7923 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7924 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7925 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7926 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7927 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7928 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7929 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7930 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7931 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7932 tracepoint as the current one.
7933
7934 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7935 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7936 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7937 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7938 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7939
7940 @smallexample
7941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7943 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7944 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7945 > tfind
7946 > end
7947
7948 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7949 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7950 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7951 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7952 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7953 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7954 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7955 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7956 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7957 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7958 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7962 the buffer:
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7967 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7968 > tfind line
7969 > end
7970
7971 Frame 0, X = 1
7972 Frame 7, X = 2
7973 Frame 13, X = 255
7974 @end smallexample
7975
7976 @node tdump
7977 @subsection @code{tdump}
7978 @kindex tdump
7979 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7980 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7981
7982 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7983 the current trace snapshot.
7984
7985 @smallexample
7986 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7988 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7989 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7990 > end
7991
7992 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7993
7994 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7995 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7996 at gdb_test.c:444
7997 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7998
7999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8000 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8001 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8002 d1 0x18 24
8003 d2 0x80 128
8004 d3 0x33 51
8005 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8006 d5 0x22 34
8007 d6 0xe0 224
8008 d7 0x380035 3670069
8009 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8010 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8011 a2 0x100 256
8012 a3 0x322000 3284992
8013 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8014 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8015 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8016 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8017 ps 0x0 0
8018 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8019 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8020 fpstatus 0x0 0
8021 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8022 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8023 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8024 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8025 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8026 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8027 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8028 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8029 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8030
8031 (@value{GDBP})
8032 @end smallexample
8033
8034 @node save-tracepoints
8035 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8036 @kindex save-tracepoints
8037 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8038
8039 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8040 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8041 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8042 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8043 Files}).
8044
8045 @node Tracepoint Variables
8046 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8047 @cindex tracepoint variables
8048 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8049
8050 @table @code
8051 @vindex $trace_frame
8052 @item (int) $trace_frame
8053 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8054 snapshot is selected.
8055
8056 @vindex $tracepoint
8057 @item (int) $tracepoint
8058 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8059
8060 @vindex $trace_line
8061 @item (int) $trace_line
8062 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8063
8064 @vindex $trace_file
8065 @item (char []) $trace_file
8066 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8067
8068 @vindex $trace_func
8069 @item (char []) $trace_func
8070 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8071 @end table
8072
8073 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8074 use @code{output} instead.
8075
8076 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8077 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8078 data.
8079
8080 @smallexample
8081 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8082
8083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8084 > output $trace_file
8085 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8086 > tfind
8087 > end
8088 @end smallexample
8089
8090 @node Overlays
8091 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8092 @cindex overlays
8093
8094 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8095 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8096 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8097 use overlays.
8098
8099 @menu
8100 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8101 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8102 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8103 mapped by asking the inferior.
8104 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8105 @end menu
8106
8107 @node How Overlays Work
8108 @section How Overlays Work
8109 @cindex mapped overlays
8110 @cindex unmapped overlays
8111 @cindex load address, overlay's
8112 @cindex mapped address
8113 @cindex overlay area
8114
8115 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8116 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8117 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8118 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8119 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8120
8121 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8122 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8123 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8124 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8125 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8126 largest overlay as well.
8127
8128 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8129 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8130 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8131 there.
8132
8133 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8134 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8135 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8136
8137 @smallexample
8138 @group
8139 Data Instruction Larger
8140 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8141 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8142 | | | | | |
8143 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8144 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8145 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8146 | and heap | | | | | |
8147 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8148 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8149 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8150 | | | | | |
8151 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8152 address | | | | | |
8153 | overlay | <-' | | |
8154 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8155 | | <---. | | load address
8156 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8157 | | | |
8158 +-----------+ | |
8159 +-----------+
8160 | |
8161 +-----------+
8162
8163 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8164 @end group
8165 @end smallexample
8166
8167 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8168 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8169 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8170 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8171 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8172 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8173 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8174 program and the overlay area.
8175
8176 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8177 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8178 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8179 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8180 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8181 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8182 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8183
8184 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8185 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8186 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8187
8188 @itemize @bullet
8189
8190 @item
8191 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8192 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8193 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8194 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8195
8196 @item
8197 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8198 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8199 your program's performance.
8200
8201 @item
8202 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8203 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8204 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8205 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8206 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8207 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8208 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8209
8210 @item
8211 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8212 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8213 instruction and data spaces.
8214
8215 @end itemize
8216
8217 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8218 improved in many ways:
8219
8220 @itemize @bullet
8221
8222 @item
8223 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8224 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8225 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8226 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8227 area in the usual way.
8228
8229 @item
8230 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8231 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8232
8233 @item
8234 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8235 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8236 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8237 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8238 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8239 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8240 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8241
8242 @end itemize
8243
8244
8245 @node Overlay Commands
8246 @section Overlay Commands
8247
8248 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8249 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8250 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8251 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8252 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8253 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8254
8255 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8256 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8257
8258 @table @code
8259 @item overlay off
8260 @kindex overlay
8261 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8262 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8263 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8264 overlay support is disabled.
8265
8266 @item overlay manual
8267 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8268 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8269 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8270 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8271 commands described below.
8272
8273 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8274 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8275 @cindex map an overlay
8276 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8277 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8278 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8279 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8280 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8281 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8282
8283 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8284 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8285 @cindex unmap an overlay
8286 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8287 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8288 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8289 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8290
8291 @item overlay auto
8292 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8293 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8294 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8295 Overlay Debugging}.
8296
8297 @item overlay load-target
8298 @itemx overlay load
8299 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8300 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8301 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8302 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8303 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8304 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8305
8306 @item overlay list-overlays
8307 @itemx overlay list
8308 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8309 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8310 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8311
8312 @end table
8313
8314 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8315 of the function the address falls in:
8316
8317 @smallexample
8318 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8319 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8320 @end smallexample
8321 @noindent
8322 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8323 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8324 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8325 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8326
8327 @smallexample
8328 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8329 No sections are mapped.
8330 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8331 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8332 @end smallexample
8333 @noindent
8334 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8335 name normally:
8336
8337 @smallexample
8338 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8339 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8340 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8341 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8342 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8343 @end smallexample
8344
8345 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8346 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8347 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8348 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8349 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8350
8351 @itemize @bullet
8352 @item
8353 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8354 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8355 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8356 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8357 @item
8358 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8359 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8360 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8361 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8362 breakpoints properly.
8363 @end itemize
8364
8365
8366 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8367 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8368 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8369
8370 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8371 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8372 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8373 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8374 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8375 current state of the overlays.
8376
8377 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8378 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8379
8380 @table @asis
8381
8382 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8383 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8384
8385 @smallexample
8386 struct
8387 @{
8388 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8389 unsigned long vma;
8390
8391 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8392 unsigned long size;
8393
8394 /* The overlay's load address. */
8395 unsigned long lma;
8396
8397 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8398 zero otherwise. */
8399 unsigned long mapped;
8400 @}
8401 @end smallexample
8402
8403 @item @code{_novlys}:
8404 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8405 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8406
8407 @end table
8408
8409 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8410 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8411 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8412 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8413 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8414 currently mapped.
8415
8416 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8417 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8418 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8419 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8420 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8421 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8422 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8423 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8424 are not being executed.
8425
8426 @node Overlay Sample Program
8427 @section Overlay Sample Program
8428 @cindex overlay example program
8429
8430 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8431 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8432 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8433 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8434 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8435 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8436 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8437
8438 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8439 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8440 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8441 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8442
8443 @table @file
8444 @item overlays.c
8445 The main program file.
8446 @item ovlymgr.c
8447 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8448 @item foo.c
8449 @itemx bar.c
8450 @itemx baz.c
8451 @itemx grbx.c
8452 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8453 @item d10v.ld
8454 @itemx m32r.ld
8455 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8456 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8457 @end table
8458
8459 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8460 cross-compiler like this:
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8464 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8465 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8466 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8467 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8468 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8469 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8470 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8471 @end smallexample
8472
8473 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8474 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8475 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8476
8477
8478 @node Languages
8479 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8480 @cindex languages
8481
8482 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8483 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8484 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8485 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8486 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8487 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8488
8489 @cindex working language
8490 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8491 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8492 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8493 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8494 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8495 language}.
8496
8497 @menu
8498 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8499 * Show:: Displaying the language
8500 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8501 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8502 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8503 @end menu
8504
8505 @node Setting
8506 @section Switching between source languages
8507
8508 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8509 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8510 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8511 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8512 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8513 are printed, etc.
8514
8515 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8516 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8517 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8518 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8519 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8520 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8521 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8522 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8523 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8524 Displaying the language}.
8525
8526 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8527 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8528 another language. In that case, make the
8529 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8530 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8531 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8532
8533 @menu
8534 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8535 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8536 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8537 @end menu
8538
8539 @node Filenames
8540 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8541
8542 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8543 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8544
8545 @table @file
8546 @item .ada
8547 @itemx .ads
8548 @itemx .adb
8549 @itemx .a
8550 Ada source file.
8551
8552 @item .c
8553 C source file
8554
8555 @item .C
8556 @itemx .cc
8557 @itemx .cp
8558 @itemx .cpp
8559 @itemx .cxx
8560 @itemx .c++
8561 C@t{++} source file
8562
8563 @item .m
8564 Objective-C source file
8565
8566 @item .f
8567 @itemx .F
8568 Fortran source file
8569
8570 @item .mod
8571 Modula-2 source file
8572
8573 @item .s
8574 @itemx .S
8575 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8576 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8577 @end table
8578
8579 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8580 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8581
8582 @node Manually
8583 @subsection Setting the working language
8584
8585 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8586 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8587 your program.
8588
8589 @kindex set language
8590 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8591 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8592 a language, such as
8593 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8594 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8595
8596 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8597 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8598 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8599 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8600 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8601 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8602 command such as:
8603
8604 @smallexample
8605 print a = b + c
8606 @end smallexample
8607
8608 @noindent
8609 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8610 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8611 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8612 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8613
8614 @node Automatically
8615 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8616
8617 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8618 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8619 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8620 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8621 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8622 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8623 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8624 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8625 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8626
8627 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8628 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8629 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8630 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8631 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8632
8633 @node Show
8634 @section Displaying the language
8635
8636 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8637 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8638
8639 @table @code
8640 @item show language
8641 @kindex show language
8642 Display the current working language. This is the
8643 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8644 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8645
8646 @item info frame
8647 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8648 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8649 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8650 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8651 information listed here.
8652
8653 @item info source
8654 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8655 Display the source language of this source file.
8656 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8657 information listed here.
8658 @end table
8659
8660 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8661 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8662 with a language explicitly:
8663
8664 @table @code
8665 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8666 @kindex set extension-language
8667 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8668 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8669
8670 @item info extensions
8671 @kindex info extensions
8672 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8673 @end table
8674
8675 @node Checks
8676 @section Type and range checking
8677
8678 @quotation
8679 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8680 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8681 section documents the intended facilities.
8682 @end quotation
8683 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8684
8685 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8686 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8687 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8688 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8689 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8690 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8691 errors when your program is running.
8692
8693 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8694 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8695 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8696 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8697 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8698 automatically based on your program's source language.
8699 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8700 settings of supported languages.
8701
8702 @menu
8703 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8704 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8705 @end menu
8706
8707 @cindex type checking
8708 @cindex checks, type
8709 @node Type Checking
8710 @subsection An overview of type checking
8711
8712 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8713 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8714 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8715 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8716
8717 @smallexample
8718 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8719 @exdent but
8720 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8721 @end smallexample
8722
8723 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8724 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8725
8726 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8727 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8728 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8729 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8730 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8731 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8732 also issues a warning.
8733
8734 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8735 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8736 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8737 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8738 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8739 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8740
8741 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8742 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8743 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8744 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8745 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8746 details on specific languages.
8747
8748 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8749
8750 @kindex set check type
8751 @kindex show check type
8752 @table @code
8753 @item set check type auto
8754 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8755 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8756 each language.
8757
8758 @item set check type on
8759 @itemx set check type off
8760 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8761 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8762 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8763 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8764 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8765
8766 @item set check type warn
8767 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8768 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8769 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8770 numbers and structures.
8771
8772 @item show type
8773 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8774 is setting it automatically.
8775 @end table
8776
8777 @cindex range checking
8778 @cindex checks, range
8779 @node Range Checking
8780 @subsection An overview of range checking
8781
8782 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8783 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8784 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8785 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8786 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8787
8788 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8789 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8790 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8791 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8792
8793 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8794 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8795 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8796 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8797 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8798 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8802 @end smallexample
8803
8804 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8805 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8806 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8807
8808 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8809
8810 @kindex set check range
8811 @kindex show check range
8812 @table @code
8813 @item set check range auto
8814 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8815 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8816 each language.
8817
8818 @item set check range on
8819 @itemx set check range off
8820 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8821 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8822 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8823 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8824
8825 @item set check range warn
8826 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8827 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8828 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8829 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8830 systems).
8831
8832 @item show range
8833 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8834 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 @node Supported languages
8838 @section Supported languages
8839
8840 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8841 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8842 @c This is false ...
8843 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8844 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8845 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8846 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8847 language.
8848
8849 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8850 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8851 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8852 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8853 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8854 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8855 language reference or tutorial.
8856
8857 @menu
8858 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8859 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8860 * Fortran:: Fortran
8861 * Pascal:: Pascal
8862 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8863 * Ada:: Ada
8864 @end menu
8865
8866 @node C
8867 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8868
8869 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8870 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8871
8872 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8873 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8874 together.
8875
8876 @cindex C@t{++}
8877 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8878 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8879 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8880 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8881 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8882 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8883 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8884
8885 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8886 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8887 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8888 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8889 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8890 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8891
8892 @menu
8893 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8894 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8895 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8896 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8897 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8898 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8899 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8900 @end menu
8901
8902 @node C Operators
8903 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8904
8905 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8906
8907 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8908 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8909 often defined on groups of types.
8910
8911 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8912
8913 @itemize @bullet
8914
8915 @item
8916 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8917 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8918
8919 @item
8920 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8921 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8922
8923 @item
8924 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8925
8926 @item
8927 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8928
8929 @end itemize
8930
8931 @noindent
8932 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8933 in order of increasing precedence:
8934
8935 @table @code
8936 @item ,
8937 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8938 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8939 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8940
8941 @item =
8942 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8943 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8944
8945 @item @var{op}=
8946 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8947 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8948 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8949 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8950 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8951
8952 @item ?:
8953 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8954 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8955 integral type.
8956
8957 @item ||
8958 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8959
8960 @item &&
8961 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8962
8963 @item |
8964 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8965
8966 @item ^
8967 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8968
8969 @item &
8970 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8971
8972 @item ==@r{, }!=
8973 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8974 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8975
8976 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8977 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8978 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8979 and non-zero for true.
8980
8981 @item <<@r{, }>>
8982 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8983
8984 @item @@
8985 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8986
8987 @item +@r{, }-
8988 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8989 pointer types.
8990
8991 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8992 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8993 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8994 integral types.
8995
8996 @item ++@r{, }--
8997 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8998 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8999 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9000 operation takes place.
9001
9002 @item *
9003 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9004 @code{++}.
9005
9006 @item &
9007 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9008
9009 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9010 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9011 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9012 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9013 stored.
9014
9015 @item -
9016 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9017 precedence as @code{++}.
9018
9019 @item !
9020 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9021 @code{++}.
9022
9023 @item ~
9024 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9025 @code{++}.
9026
9027
9028 @item .@r{, }->
9029 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9030 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9031 pointer based on the stored type information.
9032 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9033
9034 @item .*@r{, }->*
9035 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9036
9037 @item []
9038 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9039 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9040
9041 @item ()
9042 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9043
9044 @item ::
9045 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9046 and @code{class} types.
9047
9048 @item ::
9049 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9050 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9051 above.
9052 @end table
9053
9054 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9055 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9056 predefined meaning.
9057
9058 @menu
9059 * C Constants::
9060 @end menu
9061
9062 @node C Constants
9063 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9064
9065 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9066
9067 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9068 following ways:
9069
9070 @itemize @bullet
9071 @item
9072 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9073 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9074 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9075 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9076 @code{long} value.
9077
9078 @item
9079 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9080 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9081 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9082 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9083 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9084 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9085 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9086 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9087 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9088 constant.
9089
9090 @item
9091 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9092 integral equivalents.
9093
9094 @item
9095 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9096 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9097 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9098 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9099 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9100 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9101 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9102 @samp{\n} for newline.
9103
9104 @item
9105 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9106 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9107 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9108 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9109 characters.
9110
9111 @item
9112 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9113 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9114
9115 @item
9116 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9117 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9118 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9119 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9120 @end itemize
9121
9122 @menu
9123 * C plus plus expressions::
9124 * C Defaults::
9125 * C Checks::
9126
9127 * Debugging C::
9128 @end menu
9129
9130 @node C plus plus expressions
9131 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9132
9133 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9134 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9135
9136 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9137 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9138 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9139 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9140 @quotation
9141 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9142 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9143 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9144 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9145 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9146 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9147 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9148 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9149 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9150 C@t{++} code.
9151 @end quotation
9152
9153 @enumerate
9154
9155 @cindex member functions
9156 @item
9157 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9158
9159 @smallexample
9160 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9161 @end smallexample
9162
9163 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9164 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9165 @item
9166 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9167 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9168 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9169 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9170
9171 @cindex call overloaded functions
9172 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9173 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9174 @item
9175 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9176 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9177 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9178 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9179 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9180 default arguments.
9181
9182 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9183 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9184 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9185 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9186 number of function arguments.
9187
9188 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9189 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9190 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9191
9192 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9193 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9194 @smallexample
9195 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9196 @end smallexample
9197
9198 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9199 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9200
9201 @cindex reference declarations
9202 @item
9203 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9204 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9205 dereferenced.
9206
9207 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9208 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9209 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9210 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9211 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9212
9213 @item
9214 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9215 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9216 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9217 necessary, for example in an expression like
9218 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9219 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9220 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9221 @end enumerate
9222
9223 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9224 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9225 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9226 invoking user-defined operators.
9227
9228 @node C Defaults
9229 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9230
9231 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9232
9233 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9234 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9235 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9236 selects the working language.
9237
9238 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9239 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9240 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9241 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9242 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9243 for further details.
9244
9245 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9246 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9247 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9248
9249 @node C Checks
9250 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9251
9252 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9253
9254 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9255 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9256 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9257
9258 @itemize @bullet
9259 @item
9260 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9261 enumerated tag.
9262
9263 @item
9264 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9265 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9266
9267 @ignore
9268 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9269 @c FIXME--beers?
9270 @item
9271 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9272 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9273 compilers.)
9274 @end ignore
9275 @end itemize
9276
9277 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9278 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9279 that is not itself an array.
9280
9281 @node Debugging C
9282 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9283
9284 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9285 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9286 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9287 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9288
9289 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9290 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9291 ,Expressions}.
9292
9293 @menu
9294 * Debugging C plus plus::
9295 @end menu
9296
9297 @node Debugging C plus plus
9298 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9299
9300 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9301
9302 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9303 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9304
9305 @table @code
9306 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9307 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9308 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9309 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9310 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9311
9312 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9313 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9314 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9315 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9316 classes.
9317 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9318
9319 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9320 @item catch throw
9321 @itemx catch catch
9322 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9323 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9324
9325 @cindex inheritance
9326 @item ptype @var{typename}
9327 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9328 @var{typename}.
9329 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9330
9331 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9332 @item set print demangle
9333 @itemx show print demangle
9334 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9335 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9336 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9337 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9338 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9339
9340 @item set print object
9341 @itemx show print object
9342 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9343 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9344
9345 @item set print vtbl
9346 @itemx show print vtbl
9347 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9348 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9349 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9350 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9351
9352 @kindex set overload-resolution
9353 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9354 @item set overload-resolution on
9355 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9356 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9357 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9358 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9359 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9360 message.
9361
9362 @item set overload-resolution off
9363 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9364 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9365 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9366 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9367 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9368 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9369 argument types.
9370
9371 @kindex show overload-resolution
9372 @item show overload-resolution
9373 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9374
9375 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9376 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9377 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9378 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9379 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9380 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9381 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9382 @end table
9383
9384 @node Objective-C
9385 @subsection Objective-C
9386
9387 @cindex Objective-C
9388 This section provides information about some commands and command
9389 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9390 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9391 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9392
9393 @menu
9394 * Method Names in Commands::
9395 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9396 @end menu
9397
9398 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9399 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9400
9401 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9402 names as line specifications:
9403
9404 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9405 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9406 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9407 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9408 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9409 @itemize
9410 @item @code{clear}
9411 @item @code{break}
9412 @item @code{info line}
9413 @item @code{jump}
9414 @item @code{list}
9415 @end itemize
9416
9417 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9418
9419 @smallexample
9420 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9421 @end smallexample
9422
9423 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9424 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9425 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9426 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9427 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9428 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9429 debugged, enter:
9430
9431 @smallexample
9432 break -[Fruit create]
9433 @end smallexample
9434
9435 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9436 enter:
9437
9438 @smallexample
9439 list +[NSText initialize]
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9443 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9444 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9445 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9446
9447 @smallexample
9448 break create
9449 @end smallexample
9450
9451 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9452 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9453 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9454 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9455 none apply.
9456
9457 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9458 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9459
9460 @smallexample
9461 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9462 @end smallexample
9463
9464 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9465 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9466 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9467 @kindex print-object
9468 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9469
9470 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9471
9472 @smallexample
9473 print -[@var{object} hash]
9474 @end smallexample
9475
9476 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9477 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9478 @noindent
9479 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9480 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9481 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9482 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9483 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9484 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9485
9486 @node Fortran
9487 @subsection Fortran
9488 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9489
9490 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9491 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9492
9493 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9494 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9495 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9496 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9497 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9498 underscore.
9499
9500 @menu
9501 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9502 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9503 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9504 @end menu
9505
9506 @node Fortran Operators
9507 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9508
9509 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9510
9511 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9512 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9513 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9514
9515 @table @code
9516 @item **
9517 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9518 of the second one.
9519
9520 @item :
9521 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9522 represent a section of array.
9523 @end table
9524
9525 @node Fortran Defaults
9526 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9527
9528 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9529
9530 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9531 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9532 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9533 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9534
9535 @node Special Fortran commands
9536 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9537
9538 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9539
9540 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9541 such as common block displaying.
9542
9543 @table @code
9544 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9545 @kindex info common
9546 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9547 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9548 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9549 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9550 printed.
9551 @end table
9552
9553 @node Pascal
9554 @subsection Pascal
9555
9556 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9557 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9558 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9559 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9560 syntax.
9561
9562 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9563 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9564 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9565
9566 @node Modula-2
9567 @subsection Modula-2
9568
9569 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9570
9571 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9572 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9573 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9574 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9575 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9576 table.
9577
9578 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9579 @menu
9580 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9581 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9582 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9583 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9584 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9585 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9586 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9587 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9588 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9589 @end menu
9590
9591 @node M2 Operators
9592 @subsubsection Operators
9593 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9594
9595 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9596 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9597 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9598 following definitions hold:
9599
9600 @itemize @bullet
9601
9602 @item
9603 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9604 their subranges.
9605
9606 @item
9607 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9608
9609 @item
9610 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9611
9612 @item
9613 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9614 @var{type}}.
9615
9616 @item
9617 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9618
9619 @item
9620 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9621
9622 @item
9623 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9624 @end itemize
9625
9626 @noindent
9627 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9628 increasing precedence:
9629
9630 @table @code
9631 @item ,
9632 Function argument or array index separator.
9633
9634 @item :=
9635 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9636 @var{value}.
9637
9638 @item <@r{, }>
9639 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9640 types.
9641
9642 @item <=@r{, }>=
9643 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9644 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9645 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9646
9647 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9648 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9649 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9650 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9651 comment character.
9652
9653 @item IN
9654 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9655 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9656
9657 @item OR
9658 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9659
9660 @item AND@r{, }&
9661 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9662
9663 @item @@
9664 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9665
9666 @item +@r{, }-
9667 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9668 and difference on set types.
9669
9670 @item *
9671 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9672 on set types.
9673
9674 @item /
9675 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9676 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9677
9678 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9679 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9680 precedence as @code{*}.
9681
9682 @item -
9683 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9684
9685 @item ^
9686 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9687
9688 @item NOT
9689 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9690 @code{^}.
9691
9692 @item .
9693 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9694 precedence as @code{^}.
9695
9696 @item []
9697 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9698
9699 @item ()
9700 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9701 as @code{^}.
9702
9703 @item ::@r{, }.
9704 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9705 @end table
9706
9707 @quotation
9708 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9709 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9710 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9711 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9712 @end quotation
9713
9714
9715 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9716 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9717 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9718
9719 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9720 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9721
9722 @table @var
9723
9724 @item a
9725 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9726
9727 @item c
9728 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9729
9730 @item i
9731 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9732
9733 @item m
9734 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9735 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9736 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9737
9738 @item n
9739 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9740
9741 @item r
9742 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9743
9744 @item t
9745 represents a type.
9746
9747 @item v
9748 represents a variable.
9749
9750 @item x
9751 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9752 explanation of the function for details.
9753 @end table
9754
9755 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9756
9757 @table @code
9758 @item ABS(@var{n})
9759 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9760
9761 @item CAP(@var{c})
9762 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9763 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9764
9765 @item CHR(@var{i})
9766 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9767
9768 @item DEC(@var{v})
9769 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9770
9771 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9772 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9773 new value.
9774
9775 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9776 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9777 set.
9778
9779 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9780 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9781
9782 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9783 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9784
9785 @item INC(@var{v})
9786 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9787
9788 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9789 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9790 new value.
9791
9792 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9793 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9794 there. Returns the new set.
9795
9796 @item MAX(@var{t})
9797 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9798
9799 @item MIN(@var{t})
9800 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9801
9802 @item ODD(@var{i})
9803 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9804
9805 @item ORD(@var{x})
9806 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9807 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9808 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9809 integral, character and enumerated types.
9810
9811 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9812 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9813
9814 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9815 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9816
9817 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9818 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9819 @end table
9820
9821 @quotation
9822 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9823 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9824 an error.
9825 @end quotation
9826
9827 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9828 @node M2 Constants
9829 @subsubsection Constants
9830
9831 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9832 ways:
9833
9834 @itemize @bullet
9835
9836 @item
9837 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9838 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9839 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9840 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9841
9842 @item
9843 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9844 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9845 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9846 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9847 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9848 digits.
9849
9850 @item
9851 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9852 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9853 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9854 followed by a @samp{C}.
9855
9856 @item
9857 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9858 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9859 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9860 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9861 sequences.
9862
9863 @item
9864 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9865
9866 @item
9867 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9868 @code{FALSE}.
9869
9870 @item
9871 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9872
9873 @item
9874 Set constants are not yet supported.
9875 @end itemize
9876
9877 @node M2 Types
9878 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9879 @cindex Modula-2 types
9880
9881 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9882 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9883 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9884 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9885 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9886 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9887
9888 The first example contains the following section of code:
9889
9890 @smallexample
9891 VAR
9892 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9893 r: [20..40] ;
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @noindent
9897 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9898 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9899
9900 @smallexample
9901 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9902 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9903 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9904 SET OF CHAR
9905 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9906 21
9907 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9908 [20..40]
9909 @end smallexample
9910
9911 @noindent
9912 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
9913
9914 @smallexample
9915 VAR
9916 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
9917 @end smallexample
9918
9919 @noindent
9920 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
9921
9922 @smallexample
9923 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9924 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
9925 @end smallexample
9926
9927 @noindent
9928 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
9929 expressions using the debugger.
9930
9931 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
9932 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
9933
9934 @smallexample
9935 VAR
9936 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
9937 @end smallexample
9938
9939 @smallexample
9940 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9941 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
9942 @end smallexample
9943
9944 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
9945 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
9946 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
9947 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
9948
9949 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
9950
9951 @smallexample
9952 TYPE
9953 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
9954 t = [blue..yellow] ;
9955 VAR
9956 s: t ;
9957 BEGIN
9958 s := blue ;
9959 @end smallexample
9960
9961 @noindent
9962 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
9963 and value of a variable.
9964
9965 @smallexample
9966 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9967 $1 = blue
9968 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
9969 type = [blue..yellow]
9970 @end smallexample
9971
9972 @noindent
9973 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
9974 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
9975 their @code{C} counterparts.
9976
9977 @smallexample
9978 VAR
9979 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
9980 BEGIN
9981 s[1] := 1 ;
9982 @end smallexample
9983
9984 @smallexample
9985 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9986 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
9987 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9988 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
9989 @end smallexample
9990
9991 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
9992 pointer types as shown in this example:
9993
9994 @smallexample
9995 VAR
9996 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
9997 BEGIN
9998 NEW(s) ;
9999 s^[1] := 1 ;
10000 @end smallexample
10001
10002 @noindent
10003 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10004
10005 @smallexample
10006 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10007 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10008 @end smallexample
10009
10010 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10011 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10012 types:
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 TYPE
10016 foo = RECORD
10017 f1: CARDINAL ;
10018 f2: CHAR ;
10019 f3: myarray ;
10020 END ;
10021
10022 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10023 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10024 VAR
10025 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10026 @end smallexample
10027
10028 @noindent
10029 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10030 below.
10031
10032 @smallexample
10033 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10034 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10035 f1 : CARDINAL;
10036 f2 : CHAR;
10037 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10038 END
10039 @end smallexample
10040
10041 @node M2 Defaults
10042 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10043 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10044
10045 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10046 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10047 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10048 selected the working language.
10049
10050 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10051 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10052 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10053 the language automatically}, for further details.
10054
10055 @node Deviations
10056 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10057 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10058
10059 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10060 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10061
10062 @itemize @bullet
10063 @item
10064 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10065 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10066 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10067 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10068 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10069 returned a pointer.)
10070
10071 @item
10072 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10073 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10074 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10075 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10076
10077 @item
10078 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10079 argument.
10080
10081 @item
10082 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10083 @end itemize
10084
10085 @node M2 Checks
10086 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10087 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10088
10089 @quotation
10090 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10091 range checking.
10092 @end quotation
10093 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10094
10095 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10096
10097 @itemize @bullet
10098 @item
10099 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10100 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10101
10102 @item
10103 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10104 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10105 @end itemize
10106
10107 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10108 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10109
10110 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10111 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10112
10113 @node M2 Scope
10114 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10115 @cindex scope
10116 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10117 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10118 @ifinfo
10119 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10120 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10121 @end ifinfo
10122 @iftex
10123 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10124 @end iftex
10125
10126 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10127 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10128 similar syntax:
10129
10130 @smallexample
10131
10132 @var{module} . @var{id}
10133 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10134 @end smallexample
10135
10136 @noindent
10137 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10138 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10139 identifier within your program, except another module.
10140
10141 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10142 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10143 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10144 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10145
10146 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10147 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10148 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10149 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10150 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10151 @var{module}.
10152
10153 @node GDB/M2
10154 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10155
10156 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10157 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10158 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10159 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10160 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10161 analogue in Modula-2.
10162
10163 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10164 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10165 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10166 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10167 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10168 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10169
10170 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10171 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10172 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10173
10174 @node Ada
10175 @subsection Ada
10176 @cindex Ada
10177
10178 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10179 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10180 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10181 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10182 to be difficult.
10183
10184
10185 @cindex expressions in Ada
10186 @menu
10187 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10188 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10189 in @value{GDBN}.
10190 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10191 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10192 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10193 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10194 @end menu
10195
10196 @node Ada Mode Intro
10197 @subsubsection Introduction
10198 @cindex Ada mode, general
10199
10200 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10201 syntax, with some extensions.
10202 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10203
10204 @itemize @bullet
10205 @item
10206 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10207 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10208 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10209 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10210
10211 @item
10212 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10213 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10214
10215 @item
10216 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10217 @end itemize
10218
10219 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10220 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10221 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10222 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10223 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10224
10225 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10226 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10227 was translated from an Ada source file.
10228
10229 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10230 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10231 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10232 middle (to allow based literals).
10233
10234 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10235 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10236 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10237 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10238 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10239 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10240
10241 @node Omissions from Ada
10242 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10243 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10244
10245 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10246
10247 @itemize @bullet
10248 @item
10249 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10250
10251 @itemize @minus
10252 @item
10253 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10254 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10255
10256 @item
10257 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10258
10259 @item
10260 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10261
10262 @item
10263 @t{'Tag}.
10264
10265 @item
10266 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10267 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10268
10269 @item
10270 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10271 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10272
10273 @item
10274 @t{'Address}.
10275 @end itemize
10276
10277 @item
10278 The names in
10279 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10280 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10281 not currently available.
10282
10283 @item
10284 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10285 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10286 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10287 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10288 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10289 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10290 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10291 indeterminate values.
10292
10293 @item
10294 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10295 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10296 are not implemented.
10297
10298 @item
10299 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10300 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10301 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10302 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10303 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10304
10305 @smallexample
10306 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10307 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10308 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10309 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10310 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10311 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 Changing a
10315 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10316 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10317 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10318 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10319 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10320 declared to have a type such as:
10321
10322 @smallexample
10323 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10324 Id : Integer;
10325 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10326 end record;
10327 @end smallexample
10328
10329 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10330 assignments:
10331
10332 @smallexample
10333 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10334 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10335 @end smallexample
10336
10337 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10338 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10339 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10340 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10341 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10342 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10343 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10344 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10345
10346 @item
10347 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10348
10349 @item
10350 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10351 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10352 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10353 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10354 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10355
10356 @item
10357 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10358
10359 @item
10360 Entry calls are not implemented.
10361
10362 @item
10363 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10364 formats are not supported.
10365
10366 @item
10367 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10368 @end itemize
10369
10370 @node Additions to Ada
10371 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10372 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10373
10374 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10375 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10376
10377 @itemize @bullet
10378 @item
10379 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10380 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10381 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10382 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10383 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10384 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10385 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10386 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10387
10388 @item
10389 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10390 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10391 surround it in single quotes.
10392
10393 @item
10394 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10395 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10396
10397 @item
10398 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10399 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10400 @end itemize
10401
10402 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10403 to Ada:
10404
10405 @itemize @bullet
10406 @item
10407 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10408 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10409
10410 @smallexample
10411 set x := y + 3
10412 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10413 @end smallexample
10414
10415 @item
10416 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10417 the value of its right-hand operand.
10418 This allows, for example,
10419 complex conditional breaks:
10420
10421 @smallexample
10422 break f
10423 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10424 @end smallexample
10425
10426 @item
10427 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10428 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10429 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10430 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10431 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10432 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10433 in strings. For example,
10434 @smallexample
10435 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10436 @end smallexample
10437 @noindent
10438 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10439 period.
10440
10441 @item
10442 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10443 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10444 to write
10445
10446 @smallexample
10447 print 'max(x, y)
10448 @end smallexample
10449
10450 @item
10451 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10452 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10453 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10454
10455 @smallexample
10456 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10457 @end smallexample
10458
10459 @noindent
10460 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10461 clause.
10462
10463 @item
10464 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10465 multi-character subsequence of
10466 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10467 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10468 in place of @t{a'length}.
10469
10470 @item
10471 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10472 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10473 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10474 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10475 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10476 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10477 For example,
10478 @smallexample
10479 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10480 @end smallexample
10481
10482 @item
10483 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10484 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10485 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10486 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10487 object.
10488
10489 @end itemize
10490
10491 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10492 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10493
10494 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10495 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10496 before reaching the main procedure.
10497 As defined in the Ada Reference
10498 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10499 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10500 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10501 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10502
10503 @node Ada Glitches
10504 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10505 @cindex Ada, problems
10506
10507 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10508 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10509 @value{GDBN},
10510 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10511 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10512
10513 @itemize @bullet
10514 @item
10515 Currently, the debugger
10516 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10517 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10518 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10519 to get it printed properly.
10520
10521 @item
10522 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10523 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10524
10525 @item
10526 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10527 argument lists are treated as positional).
10528
10529 @item
10530 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10531
10532 @item
10533 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10534 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10535 the host machine.
10536
10537 @item
10538 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10539
10540 @item
10541 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10542 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10543 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10544 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10545 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10546 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10547 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10548 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10549 you can usually resolve the confusion
10550 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10551 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10552 @end itemize
10553
10554 @node Unsupported languages
10555 @section Unsupported languages
10556
10557 @cindex unsupported languages
10558 @cindex minimal language
10559 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10560 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10561 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10562 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10563 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10564 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10565
10566 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10567 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10568 language.
10569
10570 @node Symbols
10571 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10572
10573 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10574 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10575 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10576 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10577 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10578 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10579 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10580
10581 @cindex symbol names
10582 @cindex names of symbols
10583 @cindex quoting names
10584 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10585 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10586 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10587 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10588 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10589 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10590 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10591 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10592
10593 @smallexample
10594 p 'foo.c'::x
10595 @end smallexample
10596
10597 @noindent
10598 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10599
10600 @table @code
10601 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10602 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10603 @kindex set case-sensitive
10604 @item set case-sensitive on
10605 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10606 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10607 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10608 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10609 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10610 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10611 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10612 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10613 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10614 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10615 case-insensitive matches.
10616
10617 @kindex show case-sensitive
10618 @item show case-sensitive
10619 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10620 lookups.
10621
10622 @kindex info address
10623 @cindex address of a symbol
10624 @item info address @var{symbol}
10625 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10626 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10627 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10628 is always stored.
10629
10630 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10631 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10632 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10633
10634 @kindex info symbol
10635 @cindex symbol from address
10636 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10637 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10638 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10639 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10640 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10641
10642 @smallexample
10643 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10644 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10645 @end smallexample
10646
10647 @noindent
10648 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10649 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10650
10651 @kindex whatis
10652 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10653 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10654 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10655 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10656 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10657 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10658 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10659 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10660 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10661 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10662 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10663
10664 @kindex ptype
10665 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10666 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10667 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10668 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10669
10670 For example, for this variable declaration:
10671
10672 @smallexample
10673 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10674 @end smallexample
10675
10676 @noindent
10677 the two commands give this output:
10678
10679 @smallexample
10680 @group
10681 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10682 type = struct complex
10683 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10684 type = struct complex @{
10685 double real;
10686 double imag;
10687 @}
10688 @end group
10689 @end smallexample
10690
10691 @noindent
10692 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10693 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10694
10695 @cindex incomplete type
10696 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10697 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10698 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10699 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10700 given these declarations:
10701
10702 @smallexample
10703 struct foo;
10704 struct foo *fooptr;
10705 @end smallexample
10706
10707 @noindent
10708 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10712 $1 = <incomplete type>
10713 @end smallexample
10714
10715 @noindent
10716 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10717 completely specified.
10718
10719 @kindex info types
10720 @item info types @var{regexp}
10721 @itemx info types
10722 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10723 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10724 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10725 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10726 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10727 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10728 name is @code{value}.
10729
10730 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10731 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10732 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10733
10734 @kindex info scope
10735 @cindex local variables
10736 @item info scope @var{location}
10737 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10738 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10739 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10740 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10741
10742 @smallexample
10743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10744 Scope for command_line_handler:
10745 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10746 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10747 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10748 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10749 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10750 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10751 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10752 @end smallexample
10753
10754 @noindent
10755 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10756 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10757 collect}.
10758
10759 @kindex info source
10760 @item info source
10761 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10762 the function containing the current point of execution:
10763 @itemize @bullet
10764 @item
10765 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10766 @item
10767 the directory it was compiled in,
10768 @item
10769 its length, in lines,
10770 @item
10771 which programming language it is written in,
10772 @item
10773 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10774 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10775 @item
10776 whether the debugging information includes information about
10777 preprocessor macros.
10778 @end itemize
10779
10780
10781 @kindex info sources
10782 @item info sources
10783 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10784 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10785 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10786
10787 @kindex info functions
10788 @item info functions
10789 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10790
10791 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10792 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10793 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10794 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10795 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10796 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10797 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10798 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10799
10800 @kindex info variables
10801 @item info variables
10802 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10803 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10804
10805 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10806 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10807 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10808 @var{regexp}.
10809
10810 @kindex info classes
10811 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10812 @item info classes
10813 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10814 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10815 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10816 expression.
10817
10818 @kindex info selectors
10819 @item info selectors
10820 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10821 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10822 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10823 expression.
10824
10825 @ignore
10826 This was never implemented.
10827 @kindex info methods
10828 @item info methods
10829 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10830 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10831 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10832 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10833 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10834 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10835 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10836 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10837 @end ignore
10838
10839 @cindex reloading symbols
10840 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10841 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10842 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10843 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10844 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10845
10846 @table @code
10847 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10848 @item set symbol-reloading on
10849 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10850 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10851
10852 @item set symbol-reloading off
10853 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10854 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10855 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10856 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10857 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10858 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10859 name.
10860
10861 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10862 @item show symbol-reloading
10863 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10864 @end table
10865
10866 @cindex opaque data types
10867 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10868 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10869 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10870 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10871 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10872 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10873 another source file. The default is on.
10874
10875 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10876 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10877
10878 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10879 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10880 is printed as follows:
10881 @smallexample
10882 @{<no data fields>@}
10883 @end smallexample
10884
10885 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10886 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10887 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10888
10889 @kindex maint print symbols
10890 @cindex symbol dump
10891 @kindex maint print psymbols
10892 @cindex partial symbol dump
10893 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10894 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10895 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10896 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10897 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10898 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10899 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10900 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10901 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10902 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10903 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10904 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10905 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10906 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10907 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10908 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10909 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10910
10911 @kindex maint info symtabs
10912 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10913 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10914 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10915 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10916 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10917 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10918 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10919
10920 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10921 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10922 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10923 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10924 structure in more detail. For example:
10925
10926 @smallexample
10927 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10928 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10929 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10930 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10931 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10932 readin no
10933 fullname (null)
10934 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10935 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10936 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10937 dependencies (none)
10938 @}
10939 @}
10940 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10941 (@value{GDBP})
10942 @end smallexample
10943 @noindent
10944 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10945 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10946 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10947 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10948 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10949
10950 @smallexample
10951 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10952 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10953 line 1574.
10954 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10955 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10956 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10957 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10958 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10959 dirname (null)
10960 fullname (null)
10961 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10962 debugformat DWARF 2
10963 @}
10964 @}
10965 (@value{GDBP})
10966 @end smallexample
10967 @end table
10968
10969
10970 @node Altering
10971 @chapter Altering Execution
10972
10973 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10974 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10975 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10976 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10977 program.
10978
10979 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10980 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10981 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10982
10983 @menu
10984 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10985 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10986 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10987 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10988 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10989 * Patching:: Patching your program
10990 @end menu
10991
10992 @node Assignment
10993 @section Assignment to variables
10994
10995 @cindex assignment
10996 @cindex setting variables
10997 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
10998 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
10999
11000 @smallexample
11001 print x=4
11002 @end smallexample
11003
11004 @noindent
11005 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11006 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11007 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11008 information on operators in supported languages.
11009
11010 @kindex set variable
11011 @cindex variables, setting
11012 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11013 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11014 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11015 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11016 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11017
11018 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11019 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11020 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11021 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11022 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11023 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11024 command @code{set width}:
11025
11026 @smallexample
11027 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11028 type = double
11029 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11030 $4 = 13
11031 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11032 Invalid syntax in expression.
11033 @end smallexample
11034
11035 @noindent
11036 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11037 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11038
11039 @smallexample
11040 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11041 @end smallexample
11042
11043 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11044 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11045 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11046 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11047 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11048 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11049
11050 @smallexample
11051 @group
11052 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11053 type = double
11054 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11055 $1 = 1
11056 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11057 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11058 $2 = 1
11059 (@value{GDBP}) r
11060 The program being debugged has been started already.
11061 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11062 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11063 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11064 Invalid bfd target.
11065 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11066 The current BFD target is "=4".
11067 @end group
11068 @end smallexample
11069
11070 @noindent
11071 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11072 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11073 @code{g}, use
11074
11075 @smallexample
11076 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11077 @end smallexample
11078
11079 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11080 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11081 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11082 same length or shorter.
11083 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11084 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11085
11086 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11087 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11088 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11089 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11090 and representation in memory), and
11091
11092 @smallexample
11093 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11094 @end smallexample
11095
11096 @noindent
11097 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11098
11099 @node Jumping
11100 @section Continuing at a different address
11101
11102 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11103 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11104 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11105
11106 @table @code
11107 @kindex jump
11108 @item jump @var{linespec}
11109 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11110 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11111 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11112 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11113 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11114 breakpoints}.
11115
11116 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11117 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11118 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11119 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11120 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11121 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11122 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11123 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11124 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11125
11126 @item jump *@var{address}
11127 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11128 @end table
11129
11130 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11131 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11132 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11133 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11134 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11135 example,
11136
11137 @smallexample
11138 set $pc = 0x485
11139 @end smallexample
11140
11141 @noindent
11142 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11143 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11144 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11145
11146 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11147 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11148 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11149 detail.
11150
11151 @c @group
11152 @node Signaling
11153 @section Giving your program a signal
11154 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11155
11156 @table @code
11157 @kindex signal
11158 @item signal @var{signal}
11159 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11160 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11161 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11162 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11163
11164 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11165 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11166 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11167 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11168 signal.
11169
11170 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11171 after executing the command.
11172 @end table
11173 @c @end group
11174
11175 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11176 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11177 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11178 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11179 passes the signal directly to your program.
11180
11181
11182 @node Returning
11183 @section Returning from a function
11184
11185 @table @code
11186 @cindex returning from a function
11187 @kindex return
11188 @item return
11189 @itemx return @var{expression}
11190 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11191 command. If you give an
11192 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11193 value.
11194 @end table
11195
11196 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11197 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11198 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11199 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11200
11201 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11202 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11203 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11204 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11205 of functions.
11206
11207 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11208 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11209 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11210 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11211 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11212
11213 @node Calling
11214 @section Calling program functions
11215
11216 @table @code
11217 @cindex calling functions
11218 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11219 @item print @var{expr}
11220 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11221 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11222 debugged.
11223
11224 @kindex call
11225 @item call @var{expr}
11226 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11227 returned values.
11228
11229 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11230 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11231 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11232 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11233 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11234 value history.
11235 @end table
11236
11237 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11238 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11239 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11240 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11241
11242 @table @code
11243 @item set unwindonsignal
11244 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11245 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11246 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11247 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11248 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11249 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11250 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11251 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11252 received.
11253
11254 @item show unwindonsignal
11255 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11256 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11257 @value{GDBN}.
11258 @end table
11259
11260 @cindex weak alias functions
11261 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11262 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11263 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11264 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11265 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11266 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11267 function instead.
11268
11269 @node Patching
11270 @section Patching programs
11271
11272 @cindex patching binaries
11273 @cindex writing into executables
11274 @cindex writing into corefiles
11275
11276 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11277 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11278 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11279 patching your program's binary.
11280
11281 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11282 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11283 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11284 repairs.
11285
11286 @table @code
11287 @kindex set write
11288 @item set write on
11289 @itemx set write off
11290 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11291 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11292 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11293
11294 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11295 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11296 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11297
11298 @item show write
11299 @kindex show write
11300 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11301 as well as reading.
11302 @end table
11303
11304 @node GDB Files
11305 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11306
11307 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11308 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11309 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11310 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11311
11312 @menu
11313 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11314 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11315 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11316 @end menu
11317
11318 @node Files
11319 @section Commands to specify files
11320
11321 @cindex symbol table
11322 @cindex core dump file
11323
11324 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11325 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11326 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11327 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11328
11329 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11330 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11331 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11332 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11333 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11334
11335 @table @code
11336 @cindex executable file
11337 @kindex file
11338 @item file @var{filename}
11339 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11340 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11341 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11342 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11343 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11344 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11345 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11346 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11347
11348 @cindex unlinked object files
11349 @cindex patching object files
11350 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11351 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11352 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11353 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11354 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11355 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11356 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11357 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11358
11359 @item file
11360 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11361 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11362
11363 @kindex exec-file
11364 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11365 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11366 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11367 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11368 discard information on the executable file.
11369
11370 @kindex symbol-file
11371 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11372 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11373 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11374 table and program to run from the same file.
11375
11376 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11377 program's symbol table.
11378
11379 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11380 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11381 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11382 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11383 @value{GDBN}.
11384
11385 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11386 executing it once.
11387
11388 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11389 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11390 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11391 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11392 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11393 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11394 optimized code.
11395
11396 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11397 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11398 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11399 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11400 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11401
11402 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11403 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11404 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11405 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11406 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11407 warnings and messages}.)
11408
11409 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11410 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11411 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11412 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11413 in stabs format.
11414
11415 @kindex readnow
11416 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11417 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11418 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11419 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11420 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11421 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11422 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11423 entire symbol table available.
11424
11425 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11426 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11427 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11428 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11429 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11430 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11431 @c files.
11432
11433 @kindex core-file
11434 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11435 @itemx core
11436 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11437 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11438 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11439 executable file itself for other parts.
11440
11441 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11442 to be used.
11443
11444 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11445 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11446 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11447 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11448 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11449
11450 @kindex add-symbol-file
11451 @cindex dynamic linking
11452 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11453 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11454 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11455 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11456 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11457 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11458 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11459 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11460 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11461 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11462 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11463 @var{address} as an expression.
11464
11465 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11466 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11467 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11468 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11469 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11470
11471 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11472 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11473 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11474 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11475 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11476 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11477 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11478 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11479 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11480
11481 @itemize @bullet
11482 @item
11483 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11484 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11485 @item
11486 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11487 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11488 @item
11489 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11490 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11491 @end itemize
11492
11493 @noindent
11494 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11495 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11496 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11497 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11498 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11499 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11500 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11501 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11502 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11503 way.
11504
11505 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11506
11507 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11508 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11509 @cindex load symbols from memory
11510 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11511 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11512 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11513 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11514 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11515 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11516 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11517 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11518 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11519
11520 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11521 @kindex assf
11522 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11523 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11524 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11525 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11526 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11527 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11528 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11529 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11530 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11531 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11532
11533 @kindex section
11534 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11535 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11536 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11537 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11538 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11539 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11540 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11541 their addresses.
11542
11543 @kindex info files
11544 @kindex info target
11545 @item info files
11546 @itemx info target
11547 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11548 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11549 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11550 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11551 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11552 current ones.
11553
11554 @kindex maint info sections
11555 @item maint info sections
11556 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11557 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11558 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11559 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11560 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11561 may be arbitrarily combined):
11562
11563 @table @code
11564 @item ALLOBJ
11565 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11566 @item @var{sections}
11567 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11568 @item @var{section-flags}
11569 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11570 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11571 @table @code
11572 @item ALLOC
11573 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11574 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11575 @item LOAD
11576 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11577 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11578 @item RELOC
11579 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11580 @item READONLY
11581 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11582 @item CODE
11583 Section contains executable code only.
11584 @item DATA
11585 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11586 @item ROM
11587 Section will reside in ROM.
11588 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11589 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11590 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11591 Section is not empty.
11592 @item NEVER_LOAD
11593 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11594 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11595 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11596 COFF shared library information.
11597 @item IS_COMMON
11598 Section contains common symbols.
11599 @end table
11600 @end table
11601 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11602 @cindex read-only sections
11603 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11604 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11605 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11606 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11607 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11608 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11609 enhancement to debugging performance.
11610
11611 The default is off.
11612
11613 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11614 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11615 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11616 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11617
11618 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11619 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11620 @end table
11621
11622 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11623 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11624 name and remembers it that way.
11625
11626 @cindex shared libraries
11627 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11628 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11629
11630 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11631 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11632 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11633 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11634 debugging a core file).
11635
11636 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11637 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11638
11639 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11640 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11641 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11642
11643 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11644 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11645 particularly large or there are many of them.
11646
11647 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11648 commands:
11649
11650 @table @code
11651 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11652 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11653 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11654 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11655 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11656 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11657 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11658 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11659
11660 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11661 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11662 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11663 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11664 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11665 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11666 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11667 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11668 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11669
11670 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11671 @item show auto-solib-add
11672 Display the current autoloading mode.
11673 @end table
11674
11675 @cindex load shared library
11676 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11677 command:
11678
11679 @table @code
11680 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11681 @kindex info share
11682 @item info share
11683 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11684 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11685
11686 @kindex sharedlibrary
11687 @kindex share
11688 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11689 @itemx share @var{regex}
11690 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11691 Unix regular expression.
11692 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11693 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11694 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11695 loaded.
11696
11697 @item nosharedlibrary
11698 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11699 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11700 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11701 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11702 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11703 discarded.
11704 @end table
11705
11706 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11707 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11708 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11709
11710 @table @code
11711 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11712 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11713 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11714 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11715 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11716 shared library.
11717
11718 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11719 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11720 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11721 library events happen.
11722 @end table
11723
11724 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11725 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11726 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11727 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11728 not.
11729
11730 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11731 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11732 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11733 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11734 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11735
11736 @table @code
11737 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11738 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11739 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11740 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11741 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11742 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11743 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11744 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11745 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11746
11747 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11748 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11749 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11750 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11751
11752 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11753 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11754 Display the current shared library prefix.
11755
11756 @kindex set solib-search-path
11757 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11758 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11759 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11760 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11761 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11762 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11763 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11764 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11765
11766 @kindex show solib-search-path
11767 @item show solib-search-path
11768 Display the current shared library search path.
11769 @end table
11770
11771
11772 @node Separate Debug Files
11773 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11774 @cindex separate debugging information files
11775 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11776 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11777 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11778 @cindex global debugging information directory
11779
11780 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11781 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11782 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11783 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11784 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11785 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11786 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11787
11788 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11789 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11790 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11791 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11792 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11793 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11794 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11795 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11796 places:
11797
11798 @itemize @bullet
11799 @item
11800 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11801 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11802 @item
11803 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11804 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11805 @item
11806 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11807 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11808 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11809 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11810 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11811 @end itemize
11812 @noindent
11813 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11814 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11815 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11816
11817 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11818 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11819 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11820 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11821 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11822 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11823
11824 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11825 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11826
11827 @table @code
11828
11829 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11830 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11831 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11832 information files to @var{directory}.
11833
11834 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11835 @item show debug-file-directory
11836 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11837 information files.
11838
11839 @end table
11840
11841 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11842 @cindex debug links
11843 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11844 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11845
11846 @itemize
11847 @item
11848 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11849 a zero byte,
11850 @item
11851 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11852 boundary within the section, and
11853 @item
11854 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11855 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11856 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11857 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11858 @end itemize
11859
11860 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11861 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11862 described above.
11863
11864 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11865 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11866 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11867 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11868 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11869 in an ordinary executable.
11870
11871 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11872 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11873 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11874 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11875 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11876 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11877 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11878
11879 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11880 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11881 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11882 complete code for a function that computes it:
11883
11884 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11885 @smallexample
11886 unsigned long
11887 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11888 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11889 @{
11890 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11891 @{
11892 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11893 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11894 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11895 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11896 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11897 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11898 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11899 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11900 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11901 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11902 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11903 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11904 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11905 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11906 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11907 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11908 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11909 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11910 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11911 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11912 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11913 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11914 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11915 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11916 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11917 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11918 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11919 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11920 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11921 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11922 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11923 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11924 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11925 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11926 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11927 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11928 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11929 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11930 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11931 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11932 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11933 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11934 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11935 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11936 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11937 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11938 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11939 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11940 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11941 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11942 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11943 0x2d02ef8d
11944 @};
11945 unsigned char *end;
11946
11947 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11948 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11949 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11950 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11951 @}
11952 @end smallexample
11953
11954
11955 @node Symbol Errors
11956 @section Errors reading symbol files
11957
11958 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11959 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11960 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11961 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11962 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11963 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11964 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11965 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11966 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11967 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11968 messages}).
11969
11970 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11971
11972 @table @code
11973 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11974
11975 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11976 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11977 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11978 in its outer scope blocks.
11979
11980 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11981 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11982 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11983 function.
11984
11985 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11986
11987 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11988 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11989 do so.
11990
11991 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
11992 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
11993 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
11994 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11995 messages}.)
11996
11997 @item bad block start address patched
11998
11999 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12000 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12001 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12002
12003 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12004 starting on the previous source line.
12005
12006 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12007
12008 @cindex foo
12009 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12010 larger than the size of the string table.
12011
12012 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12013 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12014 with this name.
12015
12016 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12017
12018 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12019 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12020 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12021
12022 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12023 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12024 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12025 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12026 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12027 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12028
12029 @item stub type has NULL name
12030
12031 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12032
12033 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12034 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12035 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12036 it.
12037
12038 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12039
12040 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12041
12042 @end table
12043
12044 @node Targets
12045 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12046
12047 @cindex debugging target
12048 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12049
12050 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12051 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12052 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12053 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12054 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12055 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12056 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12057 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12058
12059 @cindex target architecture
12060 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12061 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12062 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12063 command.
12064
12065 @table @code
12066 @kindex set architecture
12067 @kindex show architecture
12068 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12069 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12070 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12071 supported architectures.
12072
12073 @item show architecture
12074 Show the current target architecture.
12075
12076 @item set processor
12077 @itemx processor
12078 @kindex set processor
12079 @kindex show processor
12080 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12081 and @code{show architecture}.
12082 @end table
12083
12084 @menu
12085 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12086 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12087 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12088 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12089
12090 @end menu
12091
12092 @node Active Targets
12093 @section Active targets
12094
12095 @cindex stacking targets
12096 @cindex active targets
12097 @cindex multiple targets
12098
12099 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12100 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12101 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12102 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12103 a core file.
12104
12105 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12106 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12107 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12108 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12109 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12110 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12111 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12112 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12113 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12114
12115 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12116 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12117 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12118 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12119 process target is active.
12120
12121 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12122 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12123 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12124 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12125 process}).
12126
12127 @node Target Commands
12128 @section Commands for managing targets
12129
12130 @table @code
12131 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12132 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12133 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12134 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12135 protocol of the target machine.
12136
12137 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12138 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12139 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12140
12141 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12142 after executing the command.
12143
12144 @kindex help target
12145 @item help target
12146 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12147 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12148 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12149
12150 @item help target @var{name}
12151 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12152 select it.
12153
12154 @kindex set gnutarget
12155 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12156 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12157 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12158 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12159 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12160 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12161
12162 @quotation
12163 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12164 you must know the actual BFD name.
12165 @end quotation
12166
12167 @noindent
12168 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12169
12170 @kindex show gnutarget
12171 @item show gnutarget
12172 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12173 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12174 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12175 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12176 @end table
12177
12178 @cindex common targets
12179 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12180 configuration):
12181
12182 @table @code
12183 @kindex target
12184 @item target exec @var{program}
12185 @cindex executable file target
12186 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12187 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12188
12189 @item target core @var{filename}
12190 @cindex core dump file target
12191 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12192 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12193
12194 @item target remote @var{medium}
12195 @cindex remote target
12196 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12197 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12198 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12199
12200 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12201 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12202
12203 @smallexample
12204 target remote /dev/ttya
12205 @end smallexample
12206
12207 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12208 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12209 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12210 clobbered by the download.
12211
12212 @item target sim
12213 @cindex built-in simulator target
12214 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12215 In general,
12216 @smallexample
12217 target sim
12218 load
12219 run
12220 @end smallexample
12221 @noindent
12222 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12223 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12224 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12225 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12226 Processors}.
12227
12228 @end table
12229
12230 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12231
12232 @table @code
12233
12234 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12235 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12236 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12237
12238 @end table
12239
12240 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12241 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12242
12243 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12244 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12245 various aspects of this process.
12246
12247 @table @code
12248
12249 @item set hash
12250 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12251 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12252 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12253 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12254 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12255 monitor.
12256
12257 @item show hash
12258 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12259 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12260
12261 @item set debug monitor
12262 @kindex set debug monitor
12263 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12264 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12265 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12266
12267 @item show debug monitor
12268 @kindex show debug monitor
12269 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12270 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12271 @end table
12272
12273 @table @code
12274
12275 @kindex load @var{filename}
12276 @item load @var{filename}
12277 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12278 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12279 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12280 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12281 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12282 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12283
12284 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12285 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12286 target is @dots{}}''
12287
12288 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12289 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12290 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12291 specifies a fixed address.
12292 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12293
12294 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12295 load programs into flash memory.
12296
12297 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12298 @end table
12299
12300 @node Byte Order
12301 @section Choosing target byte order
12302
12303 @cindex choosing target byte order
12304 @cindex target byte order
12305
12306 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12307 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12308 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12309 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12310 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12311 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12312
12313 @table @code
12314 @kindex set endian
12315 @item set endian big
12316 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12317
12318 @item set endian little
12319 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12320
12321 @item set endian auto
12322 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12323 executable.
12324
12325 @item show endian
12326 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12327
12328 @end table
12329
12330 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12331 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12332 target system.
12333
12334 @node Remote
12335 @section Remote debugging
12336 @cindex remote debugging
12337
12338 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12339 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12340 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12341 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12342 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12343
12344 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12345 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12346 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12347 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12348 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12349 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12350
12351 Other remote targets may be available in your
12352 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12353
12354 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12355 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12356
12357 @table @code
12358 @item remote @var{command}
12359 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12360 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12361 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12362 @end table
12363
12364
12365 @node Remote Debugging
12366 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12367
12368 @menu
12369 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12370 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12371 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12372 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12373 @end menu
12374
12375 @node Connecting
12376 @section Connecting to a remote target
12377
12378 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12379 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12380 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12381 program as the first argument.
12382
12383 @cindex @code{target remote}
12384 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12385 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12386 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12387 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12388 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12389 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12390
12391 @table @code
12392
12393 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12394 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12395 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12396 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12397
12398 @smallexample
12399 target remote /dev/ttyb
12400 @end smallexample
12401
12402 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12403 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12404 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12405 @code{target} command.
12406
12407 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12408 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12409 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12410 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12411 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12412 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12413 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12414 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12415 target.
12416
12417 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12418 @code{manyfarms}:
12419
12420 @smallexample
12421 target remote manyfarms:2828
12422 @end smallexample
12423
12424 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12425 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12426 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12427 port 1234 on your local machine:
12428
12429 @smallexample
12430 target remote :1234
12431 @end smallexample
12432 @noindent
12433
12434 Note that the colon is still required here.
12435
12436 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12437 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12438 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12439 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12440
12441 @smallexample
12442 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12443 @end smallexample
12444
12445 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12446 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12447 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12448 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12449
12450 @item target remote | @var{command}
12451 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12452 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12453 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12454 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12455 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12456 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12457 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12458 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12459
12460 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12461 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12462 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12463
12464 @end table
12465
12466 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12467 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12468 remote program.
12469
12470 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12471 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12472 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12473 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12474 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12475 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12476 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12477
12478 @smallexample
12479 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12480 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12481 @end smallexample
12482
12483 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12484 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12485 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12486 goes back to waiting.
12487
12488 @table @code
12489 @kindex detach (remote)
12490 @item detach
12491 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12492 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12493 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12494 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12495 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12496
12497 @kindex disconnect
12498 @item disconnect
12499 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12500 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12501 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12502 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12503 another target.
12504
12505 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12506 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12507 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12508 @kindex monitor
12509 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12510 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12511 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12512 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12513 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12514 and implement.
12515 @end table
12516
12517 @node Server
12518 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12519
12520 @kindex gdbserver
12521 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12522 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12523 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12524 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12525
12526 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12527 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12528 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12529 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12530 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12531 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12532 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12533 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12534 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12535 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12536 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12537 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12538 choice for debugging.
12539
12540 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12541 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12542 protocol.
12543
12544 @table @emph
12545 @item On the target machine,
12546 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12547 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12548 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12549 system does all the symbol handling.
12550
12551 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12552 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12553 syntax is:
12554
12555 @smallexample
12556 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12557 @end smallexample
12558
12559 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12560 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12561 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12562 @file{/dev/com1}:
12563
12564 @smallexample
12565 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12566 @end smallexample
12567
12568 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12569 with it.
12570
12571 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12572
12573 @smallexample
12574 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12575 @end smallexample
12576
12577 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12578 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12579 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12580 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12581 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12582 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12583 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12584 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12585 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12586 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12587 @code{target remote} command.
12588
12589 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12590 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12591
12592 @smallexample
12593 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12594 @end smallexample
12595
12596 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12597 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12598
12599 @pindex pidof
12600 @cindex attach to a program by name
12601 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12602 @code{pidof} utility:
12603
12604 @smallexample
12605 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12606 @end smallexample
12607
12608 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12609 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12610 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12611
12612 @item On the host machine,
12613 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12614 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12615 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12616 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12617 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12618 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12619 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12620 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12621 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12622 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12623 program is considered running after the connection.
12624
12625 @end table
12626
12627 @node Remote configuration
12628 @section Remote configuration
12629
12630 @kindex set remote
12631 @kindex show remote
12632 This section documents the configuration options available when
12633 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12634 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12635 system-call-allowed}.
12636
12637 @table @code
12638 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12639 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12640 @cindex bits in remote address
12641 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12642 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12643 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12644 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12645
12646 @item show remoteaddresssize
12647 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12648
12649 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12650 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12651 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12652 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12653 remote targets.
12654
12655 @item show remotebaud
12656 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12657
12658 @item set remotebreak
12659 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12660 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12661 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12662 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12663 when you press the @key{Ctrl-C} key to interrupt the program running
12664 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12665 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12666 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12667
12668 @item show remotebreak
12669 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12670 interrupt the remote program.
12671
12672 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12673 @cindex serial port name
12674 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12675 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12676 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12677 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12678 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12679 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12680 arguments.)
12681
12682 @item show remotedevice
12683 Show the current name of the serial port.
12684
12685 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12686 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12687 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12688 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12689 @code{ascii}.
12690
12691 @item show remotelogbase
12692 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12693 protocol.
12694
12695 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12696 @cindex record serial communications on file
12697 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12698 default is not to record at all.
12699
12700 @item show remotelogfile.
12701 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12702 serial communications.
12703
12704 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12705 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12706 @cindex remote timeout
12707 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12708 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12709
12710 @item show remotetimeout
12711 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12712 responses.
12713
12714 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12715 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12716 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12717 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12718 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12719 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12720 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12721 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12722
12723 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12724 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12725 @itemx set remote P-packet
12726 @itemx set remote p-packet
12727 @cindex P-packet
12728 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12729 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12730 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12731 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12732 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12733 the stub when this packet is first required).
12734
12735 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12736 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12737 @itemx show remote P-packet
12738 @itemx show remote p-packet
12739 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12740 fetching registers from the remote target.
12741
12742 @cindex binary downloads
12743 @cindex X-packet
12744 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12745 @itemx set remote X-packet
12746 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12747 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12748
12749 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12750 @itemx show remote X-packet
12751 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12752 downloads.
12753
12754 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12755 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12756 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12757 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} (target
12758 auxiliary vector) request. This request is used to fetch the
12759 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12760 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12761 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12762 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qXfer}, for
12763 more information about this request.
12764
12765 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12766 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} request.
12767
12768 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12769 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12770 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12771 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12772 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12773 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12774 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12775 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12776 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12777 request.
12778
12779 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12780 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12781
12782 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12783 @cindex resume remote target
12784 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12785 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12786 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12787 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12788 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12789 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12790 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12791 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12792 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12793 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12794 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12795 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12796 more details.
12797
12798 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12799 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12800
12801 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12802 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12803 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12804 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12805 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12806 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12807 @cindex Z-packet
12808 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12809 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12810 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12811 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12812 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12813 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12814 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12815 packets.
12816
12817 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12818 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12819 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12820 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12821 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12822 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12823 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12824
12825 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12826 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12827 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12828 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12829 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12830 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12831 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12832 packet.
12833
12834 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12835 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12836 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12837
12838 @item set remote supported-packets
12839 @kindex set remote supported-packets
12840 @cindex query supported packets of remote targets
12841 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qSupported}
12842 request packet. @xref{General Query Packets, qSupported}, for more
12843 details about this packet. The default is to use @samp{qSupported}.
12844
12845 @item show remote supported-packets
12846 @kindex show remote supported-packets
12847 Show the current setting of @samp{qSupported} packet usage.
12848 @end table
12849
12850 @node remote stub
12851 @section Implementing a remote stub
12852
12853 @cindex debugging stub, example
12854 @cindex remote stub, example
12855 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12856 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12857 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12858 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12859 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12860 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12861 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12862 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12863
12864 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12865 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12866 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12867 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12868 program, you need:
12869
12870 @enumerate
12871 @item
12872 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12873 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12874 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12875
12876 @item
12877 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12878 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12879
12880 @item
12881 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12882 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12883 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12884 documentation.
12885 @end enumerate
12886
12887 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12888 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12889 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12890
12891 @table @emph
12892 @item On the host,
12893 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12894 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12895 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12896
12897 @item On the target,
12898 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12899 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12900 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12901
12902 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12903 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12904 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12905 @end table
12906
12907 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12908 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12909 @sc{sparc} boards.
12910
12911 @cindex remote serial stub list
12912 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12913
12914 @table @code
12915
12916 @item i386-stub.c
12917 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12918 @cindex Intel
12919 @cindex i386
12920 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12921
12922 @item m68k-stub.c
12923 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12924 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12925 @cindex m680x0
12926 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12927
12928 @item sh-stub.c
12929 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12930 @cindex Renesas
12931 @cindex SH
12932 For Renesas SH architectures.
12933
12934 @item sparc-stub.c
12935 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12936 @cindex Sparc
12937 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12938
12939 @item sparcl-stub.c
12940 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12941 @cindex Fujitsu
12942 @cindex SparcLite
12943 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12944
12945 @end table
12946
12947 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12948 recently added stubs.
12949
12950 @menu
12951 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12952 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12953 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12954 @end menu
12955
12956 @node Stub Contents
12957 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12958
12959 @cindex remote serial stub
12960 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12961 subroutines:
12962
12963 @table @code
12964 @item set_debug_traps
12965 @findex set_debug_traps
12966 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12967 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12968 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12969 beginning of your program.
12970
12971 @item handle_exception
12972 @findex handle_exception
12973 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12974 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12975 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12976 run when a trap is triggered.
12977
12978 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12979 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12980 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12981 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12982 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12983 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12984 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12985 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12986 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12987 machine.
12988
12989 @item breakpoint
12990 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12991 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12992 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12993 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12994 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12995 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12996 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12997 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12998 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12999 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13000 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13001
13002 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13003 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13004 start of your debugging session.
13005 @end table
13006
13007 @node Bootstrapping
13008 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13009
13010 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13011 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13012 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13013 debugging target machine.
13014
13015 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13016 serial port.
13017
13018 @table @code
13019 @item int getDebugChar()
13020 @findex getDebugChar
13021 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13022 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13023 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13024
13025 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13026 @findex putDebugChar
13027 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13028 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13029 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13030 @end table
13031
13032 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13033 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13034 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13035 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13036 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13037 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13038 remote system to stop.
13039
13040 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13041 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13042 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13043 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13044
13045 Other routines you need to supply are:
13046
13047 @table @code
13048 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13049 @findex exceptionHandler
13050 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13051 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13052 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13053 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13054 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13055 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13056 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13057 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13058 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13059 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13060 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13061 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13062 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13063
13064 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13065 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13066 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13067 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13068 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13069
13070 @item void flush_i_cache()
13071 @findex flush_i_cache
13072 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13073 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13074 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13075
13076 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13077 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13078 @end table
13079
13080 @noindent
13081 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13082
13083 @table @code
13084 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13085 @findex memset
13086 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13087 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13088 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13089 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13090 @end table
13091
13092 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13093 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13094 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13095 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13096
13097
13098 @node Debug Session
13099 @subsection Putting it all together
13100
13101 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13102 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13103 steps.
13104
13105 @enumerate
13106 @item
13107 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13108 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13109 @display
13110 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13111 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13112 @end display
13113
13114 @item
13115 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13116
13117 @smallexample
13118 set_debug_traps();
13119 breakpoint();
13120 @end smallexample
13121
13122 @item
13123 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13124 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13125
13126 @smallexample
13127 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13128 @end smallexample
13129
13130 @noindent
13131 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13132 function in your program, that function is called when
13133 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13134 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13135 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13136
13137 @item
13138 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13139 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13140
13141 @item
13142 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13143 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13144
13145 @item
13146 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13147 @c document that. FIXME.
13148 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13149 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13150
13151 @item
13152 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13153 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13154
13155 @end enumerate
13156
13157 @node Configurations
13158 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13159
13160 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13161 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13162 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13163
13164 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13165 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13166 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13167 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13168 are quite different from each other.
13169
13170 @menu
13171 * Native::
13172 * Embedded OS::
13173 * Embedded Processors::
13174 * Architectures::
13175 @end menu
13176
13177 @node Native
13178 @section Native
13179
13180 This section describes details specific to particular native
13181 configurations.
13182
13183 @menu
13184 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13185 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13186 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13187 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13188 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13189 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13190 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13191 @end menu
13192
13193 @node HP-UX
13194 @subsection HP-UX
13195
13196 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13197 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13198 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13199
13200
13201 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13202 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13203
13204 @cindex libkvm
13205 @cindex kernel memory image
13206 @cindex kernel crash dump
13207
13208 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13209 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13210 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13211 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13212 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13213 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13214 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13215 @code{kvm} target:
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13219 @end smallexample
13220
13221 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13222 argument:
13223
13224 @smallexample
13225 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13226 @end smallexample
13227
13228 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13229 available:
13230
13231 @table @code
13232 @kindex kvm
13233 @item kvm pcb
13234 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13235
13236 @item kvm proc
13237 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13238 modern FreeBSD systems.
13239 @end table
13240
13241 @node SVR4 Process Information
13242 @subsection SVR4 process information
13243 @cindex /proc
13244 @cindex examine process image
13245 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13246
13247 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13248 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13249 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13250 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13251 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13252 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13253 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13254 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13255 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13256
13257 @table @code
13258 @kindex info proc
13259 @cindex process ID
13260 @item info proc
13261 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13262 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13263 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13264 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13265 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13266 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13267 executable file's absolute file name.
13268
13269 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13270 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13271 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13272 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13273 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13274 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13275
13276 @item info proc mappings
13277 @cindex memory address space mappings
13278 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13279 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13280 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13281 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13282 memory access rights to that range.
13283
13284 @item info proc stat
13285 @itemx info proc status
13286 @cindex process detailed status information
13287 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13288 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13289 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13290 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13291 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13292 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13293 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13294
13295 @item info proc all
13296 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13297 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13298
13299 @ignore
13300 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13301 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13302 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13303 @kindex info proc times
13304 @item info proc times
13305 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13306 its children.
13307
13308 @kindex info proc id
13309 @item info proc id
13310 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13311 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13312 @end ignore
13313
13314 @item set procfs-trace
13315 @kindex set procfs-trace
13316 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13317 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13318
13319 @item show procfs-trace
13320 @kindex show procfs-trace
13321 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13322
13323 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13324 @kindex set procfs-file
13325 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13326 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13327 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13328 standard output.
13329
13330 @item show procfs-file
13331 @kindex show procfs-file
13332 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13333
13334 @item proc-trace-entry
13335 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13336 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13337 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13338 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13339 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13340 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13341 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13342 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13343 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13344
13345 @item info pidlist
13346 @kindex info pidlist
13347 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13348 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13349 processes and all the threads within each process.
13350
13351 @item info meminfo
13352 @kindex info meminfo
13353 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13354 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13355 @end table
13356
13357 @node DJGPP Native
13358 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13359 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13360 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13361 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13362
13363 @cindex DPMI
13364 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13365 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13366 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13367 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13368
13369 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13370 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13371 subsection describes those commands.
13372
13373 @table @code
13374 @kindex info dos
13375 @item info dos
13376 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13377 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13378
13379 @kindex sysinfo
13380 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13381 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13382 @item info dos sysinfo
13383 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13384 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13385 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13386
13387 @cindex GDT
13388 @cindex LDT
13389 @cindex IDT
13390 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13391 @cindex descriptor tables display
13392 @item info dos gdt
13393 @itemx info dos ldt
13394 @itemx info dos idt
13395 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13396 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13397 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13398 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13399 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13400 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13401 rights.
13402
13403 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13404 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13405 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13406 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13407 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13408
13409 @cindex garbled pointers
13410 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13411 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13412 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13413 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13414 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13415 debugged program's data segment:
13416
13417 @smallexample
13418 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13419 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13420 @end smallexample
13421
13422 @noindent
13423 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13424 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13425
13426 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13427 @item info dos pde
13428 @itemx info dos pte
13429 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13430 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13431 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13432 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13433 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13434 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13435 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13436 that is currently in use.
13437
13438 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13439 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13440 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13441 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13442 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13443 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13444 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13445
13446 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13447 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13448 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13449 controller.
13450
13451 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13452
13453 @cindex physical address from linear address
13454 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13455 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13456 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13457 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13458 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13459 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13460 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13461
13462 @smallexample
13463 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13464 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13465 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13466 @end smallexample
13467
13468 @noindent
13469 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13470 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13471 attributes of that page.
13472
13473 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13474 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13475 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13476 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13477 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13478 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13479
13480 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13481 transfer buffer:
13482
13483 @smallexample
13484 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13485 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13486 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13491 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13492 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13493 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13494 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13495
13496 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13497 @end table
13498
13499 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13500 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13501 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13502 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13503
13504 @table @code
13505 @kindex set com1base
13506 @kindex set com1irq
13507 @kindex set com2base
13508 @kindex set com2irq
13509 @kindex set com3base
13510 @kindex set com3irq
13511 @kindex set com4base
13512 @kindex set com4irq
13513 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13514 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13515 port.
13516
13517 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13518 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13519 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13520
13521 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13522 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13523 other 3 COM ports.
13524
13525 @kindex show com1base
13526 @kindex show com1irq
13527 @kindex show com2base
13528 @kindex show com2irq
13529 @kindex show com3base
13530 @kindex show com3irq
13531 @kindex show com4base
13532 @kindex show com4irq
13533 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13534 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13535 lines used by the COM ports.
13536
13537 @item info serial
13538 @kindex info serial
13539 @cindex DOS serial port status
13540 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13541 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13542 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13543 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13544 @end table
13545
13546
13547 @node Cygwin Native
13548 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13549 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13550 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13551 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13552
13553 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13554 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13555 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13556 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13557 that have no debugging symbols.
13558
13559
13560 @table @code
13561 @kindex info w32
13562 @item info w32
13563 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13564 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13565
13566 @item info w32 selector
13567 This command displays information returned by
13568 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13569 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13570 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13571 Without argument, this command displays information
13572 about the the six segment registers.
13573
13574 @kindex info dll
13575 @item info dll
13576 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13577
13578 @kindex dll-symbols
13579 @item dll-symbols
13580 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13581 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13582
13583 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13584 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13585 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13586 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13587 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13588 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13589 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13590 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13591 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13592 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13593 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13594
13595 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13596 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13597 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13598 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13599
13600 @kindex set new-console
13601 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13602 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13603 be started in a new console on next start.
13604 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13605 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13606
13607 @kindex show new-console
13608 @item show new-console
13609 Displays whether a new console is used
13610 when the debuggee is started.
13611
13612 @kindex set new-group
13613 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13614 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13615 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13616 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13617 Ctrl-C.
13618
13619 @kindex show new-group
13620 @item show new-group
13621 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13622
13623 @kindex set debugevents
13624 @item set debugevents
13625 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13626 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13627 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13628 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13629 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13630
13631 @kindex set debugexec
13632 @item set debugexec
13633 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13634 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13635
13636 @kindex set debugexceptions
13637 @item set debugexceptions
13638 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13639 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13640
13641 @kindex set debugmemory
13642 @item set debugmemory
13643 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13644 and writes by the debugger.
13645
13646 @kindex set shell
13647 @item set shell
13648 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13649 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13650
13651 @kindex show shell
13652 @item show shell
13653 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13654
13655 @end table
13656
13657 @menu
13658 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13659 @end menu
13660
13661 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13662 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13663 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13664 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13665
13666 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13667 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13668 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13669 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13670 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13671 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13672 ``minimal symbols''.
13673
13674 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13675 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13676 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13677 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13678 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13679 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13680 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13681 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13682 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13683 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13684
13685 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13686
13687 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13688 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13689 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13690 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13691 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13692 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13693 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13694 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13695 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13696
13697 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13698 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13699 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13700 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13701 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13702 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13703
13704 @smallexample
13705 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13706 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13707
13708 Non-debugging symbols:
13709 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13710 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13711 @end smallexample
13712
13713 @smallexample
13714 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13715 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13716
13717 Non-debugging symbols:
13718 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13719 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13720 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13721 [etc...]
13722 @end smallexample
13723
13724 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13725
13726 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13727 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13728 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13729 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13730 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13731 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13732 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13733
13734 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13735 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13736 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13737 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13738 problem:
13739
13740 @smallexample
13741 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13742 $1 = 268572168
13743 @end smallexample
13744
13745 @smallexample
13746 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13747 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13748 @end smallexample
13749
13750 And two possible solutions:
13751
13752 @smallexample
13753 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13754 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13755 @end smallexample
13756
13757 @smallexample
13758 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13759 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13760 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13761 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13762 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13763 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13764 @end smallexample
13765
13766 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13767 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13768 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13769 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13770 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13771
13772 @smallexample
13773 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13774 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13775 @end smallexample
13776
13777 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13778 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13779 safe.
13780
13781 @node Hurd Native
13782 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13783 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13784
13785 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13786 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13787
13788 @table @code
13789 @item set signals
13790 @itemx set sigs
13791 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13792 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13793 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13794 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13795 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13796 @code{signals}.
13797
13798 @item show signals
13799 @itemx show sigs
13800 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13801 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13802 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13803
13804 @item set signal-thread
13805 @itemx set sigthread
13806 @kindex set signal-thread
13807 @kindex set sigthread
13808 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13809 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13810 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13811 signal-thread}.
13812
13813 @item show signal-thread
13814 @itemx show sigthread
13815 @kindex show signal-thread
13816 @kindex show sigthread
13817 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13818 delivered a signal.
13819
13820 @item set stopped
13821 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13822 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13823 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13824 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13825
13826 @item show stopped
13827 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13828 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13829 stopped.
13830
13831 @item set exceptions
13832 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13833 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13834 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13835 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13836 trapping on.
13837
13838 @item show exceptions
13839 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13840 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13841
13842 @item set task pause
13843 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13844 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13845 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13846 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13847 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13848 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13849 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13850 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13851 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13852
13853 @item show task pause
13854 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13855 Show the current state of task suspension.
13856
13857 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13858 @cindex task suspend count
13859 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13860 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13861 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13862
13863 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13864 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13865
13866 @item set task exception-port
13867 @itemx set task excp
13868 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13869 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13870 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13871 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13872
13873 @item set noninvasive
13874 @cindex noninvasive task options
13875 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13876 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13877 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13878 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13879
13880 @item info send-rights
13881 @itemx info receive-rights
13882 @itemx info port-rights
13883 @itemx info port-sets
13884 @itemx info dead-names
13885 @itemx info ports
13886 @itemx info psets
13887 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13888 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13889 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13890 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13891 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13892 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13893 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13894 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13895 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13896
13897 @item set thread pause
13898 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13899 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13900 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13901 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13902 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13903 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13904 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13905 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13906 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13907 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13908 only the current thread.
13909
13910 @item show thread pause
13911 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13912 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13913
13914 @item set thread run
13915 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13916
13917 @item show thread run
13918 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13919
13920 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13921 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13922 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13923 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13924 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13925 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13926 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13927
13928 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13929 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13930 detaching.
13931
13932 @item set thread exception-port
13933 @itemx set thread excp
13934 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13935 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13936 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13937
13938 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13939 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13940 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13941 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13942
13943 @item set thread default
13944 @itemx show thread default
13945 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13946 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13947 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13948 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13949 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13950 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13951 the non-default commands.
13952 @end table
13953
13954
13955 @node Neutrino
13956 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13957 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13958
13959 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13960 Neutrino target:
13961
13962 @table @code
13963 @item set debug nto-debug
13964 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13965 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13966 Neutrino support.
13967
13968 @item show debug nto-debug
13969 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13970 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13971 @end table
13972
13973
13974 @node Embedded OS
13975 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13976
13977 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13978 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13979 architectures.
13980
13981 @menu
13982 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13983 @end menu
13984
13985 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13986 various real-time operating systems.
13987
13988 @node VxWorks
13989 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13990
13991 @cindex VxWorks
13992
13993 @table @code
13994
13995 @kindex target vxworks
13996 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13997 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13998 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13999
14000 @end table
14001
14002 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14003 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14004
14005 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14006 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14007 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14008 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14009 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14010 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14011 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14012
14013 @table @code
14014 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14015 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14016 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14017 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14018 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14019 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14020 of a thin network line.
14021 @end table
14022
14023 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14024 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14025 procedures.
14026
14027 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14028 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14029 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14030 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14031 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14032 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14033 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14034 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14035 manual.
14036 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14037
14038 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14039 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14040 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14041 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14042
14043 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14044
14045 @smallexample
14046 (vxgdb)
14047 @end smallexample
14048
14049 @menu
14050 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14051 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14052 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14053 @end menu
14054
14055 @node VxWorks Connection
14056 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14057
14058 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14059 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14060
14061 @smallexample
14062 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14063 @end smallexample
14064
14065 @need 750
14066 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14067
14068 @smallexample
14069 Attaching remote machine across net...
14070 Connected to tt.
14071 @end smallexample
14072
14073 @need 1000
14074 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14075 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14076 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14077 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14078 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14079
14080 @smallexample
14081 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14082 @end smallexample
14083
14084 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14085 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14086 command again.
14087
14088 @node VxWorks Download
14089 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14090
14091 @cindex download to VxWorks
14092 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14093 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14094 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14095 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14096 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14097 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14098 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14099 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14100 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14101 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14102 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14103 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14104 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14105 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14106 program, type this on VxWorks:
14107
14108 @smallexample
14109 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14110 @end smallexample
14111
14112 @noindent
14113 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14114
14115 @smallexample
14116 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14117 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14118 @end smallexample
14119
14120 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14121
14122 @smallexample
14123 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14124 @end smallexample
14125
14126 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14127 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14128 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14129 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14130 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14131 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14132 table.)
14133
14134 @node VxWorks Attach
14135 @subsubsection Running tasks
14136
14137 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14138 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14139 follows:
14140
14141 @smallexample
14142 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14143 @end smallexample
14144
14145 @noindent
14146 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14147 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14148 the time of attachment.
14149
14150 @node Embedded Processors
14151 @section Embedded Processors
14152
14153 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14154 configurations.
14155
14156 @cindex send command to simulator
14157 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14158 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14159
14160 @table @code
14161 @item sim @var{command}
14162 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14163 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14164 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14165 acceptable commands.
14166 @end table
14167
14168
14169 @menu
14170 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14171 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14172 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14173 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14174 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14175 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14176 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14177 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14178 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14179 * SH:: Renesas SH
14180 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14181 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14182 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14183 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14184 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14185 * CRIS:: CRIS
14186 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14187 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14188 @end menu
14189
14190 @node ARM
14191 @subsection ARM
14192 @cindex ARM RDI
14193
14194 @table @code
14195 @kindex target rdi
14196 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14197 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14198 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14199 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14200
14201 @kindex target rdp
14202 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14203 ARM Demon monitor.
14204
14205 @end table
14206
14207 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14208
14209 @table @code
14210 @item set arm disassembler
14211 @kindex set arm
14212 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14213 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14214
14215 @item show arm disassembler
14216 @kindex show arm
14217 Show the current disassembly style.
14218
14219 @item set arm apcs32
14220 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14221 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14222
14223 @item show arm apcs32
14224 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14225
14226 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14227 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14228 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14229
14230 @table @code
14231 @item auto
14232 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14233 @item softfpa
14234 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14235 processors.
14236 @item fpa
14237 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14238 @item softvfp
14239 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14240 @item vfp
14241 VFP co-processor.
14242 @end table
14243
14244 @item show arm fpu
14245 Show the current type of the FPU.
14246
14247 @item set arm abi
14248 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14249
14250 @item show arm abi
14251 Show the currently used ABI.
14252
14253 @item set debug arm
14254 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14255 target support subsystem.
14256
14257 @item show debug arm
14258 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14259 @end table
14260
14261 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14262 using the RDI interface:
14263
14264 @table @code
14265 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14266 @kindex rdilogfile
14267 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14268 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14269 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14270 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14271 @file{rdi.log}.
14272
14273 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14274 @kindex rdilogenable
14275 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14276 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14277 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14278 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14279 are logged to a file.
14280
14281 @item set rdiromatzero
14282 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14283 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14284 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14285 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14286 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14287 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14288
14289 @item show rdiromatzero
14290 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14291 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14292
14293 @item set rdiheartbeat
14294 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14295 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14296 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14297 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14298 well as the Angel monitor.
14299
14300 @item show rdiheartbeat
14301 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14302 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14303 @end table
14304
14305
14306 @node H8/300
14307 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14308
14309 @table @code
14310
14311 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14312 @item target hms @var{dev}
14313 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14314 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14315 line and the communications speed used.
14316
14317 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14318 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14319 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14320
14321 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14322 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14323 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14324 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14325 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14326
14327 @end table
14328
14329 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14330 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14331 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14332 @cindex Renesas SH download
14333 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14334 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14335 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14336 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14337
14338 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14339 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14340
14341 @enumerate
14342 @item
14343 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14344 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14345 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14346 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14347 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14348
14349 @item
14350 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14351 serial device available on your host is the default).
14352
14353 @item
14354 what speed to use over the serial device.
14355 @end enumerate
14356
14357 @menu
14358 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14359 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14360 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14361 @end menu
14362
14363 @node Renesas Boards
14364 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14365
14366 @c only for Unix hosts
14367 @kindex device
14368 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14369 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14370 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14371 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14372 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14373
14374 @kindex speed
14375 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14376 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14377 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14378 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14379 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14380 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14381
14382 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14383 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14384 use a DOS host,
14385 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14386 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14387 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14388 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14389
14390 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14391 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14392 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14393 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14394
14395 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14396 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14397 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14398 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14399 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14400 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14401 @code{COM2}.
14402
14403 @smallexample
14404 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14405 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14406
14407 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14408
14409 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14410
14411 @end smallexample
14412
14413 @quotation
14414 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14415 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14416 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14417 your development board.
14418 @end quotation
14419
14420 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14421 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14422 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14423 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14424 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14425 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14426 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14427 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14428 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14429 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14430 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14431 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14432 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14433
14434 @smallexample
14435 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14436 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14437 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14438 the conditions.
14439 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14440 for details.
14441 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14442 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14443 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14444 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14445 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14446 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14447 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14448 @end smallexample
14449
14450 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14451 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14452 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14453 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14454 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14455 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14456
14457 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14458 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14459 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14460
14461 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14462 @itemize @bullet
14463 @item
14464 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
14465 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14466
14467 @item
14468 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14469 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14470 to detect program completion.
14471 @end itemize
14472
14473 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14474 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14475
14476 @node Renesas ICE
14477 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14478
14479 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14480 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14481 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14482 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14483
14484 @table @code
14485 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14486 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14487 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14488 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14489 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14490
14491 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14492 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14493 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14494 @end table
14495
14496 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14497 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14498
14499 @table @code
14500 @item e7000 @var{command}
14501 @kindex e7000
14502 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14503 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14504
14505 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14506 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14507 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14508 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14509 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14510 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14511
14512 @item ftpload @var{file}
14513 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14514 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14515 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14516
14517 @item drain
14518 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14519 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14520
14521 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14522 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14523 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14524 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14525 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14526 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14527 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14528 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14529 @end table
14530
14531 @node Renesas Special
14532 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14533
14534 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14535
14536 @table @code
14537
14538 @kindex set machine
14539 @kindex show machine
14540 @item set machine h8300
14541 @itemx set machine h8300h
14542 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14543 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14544 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14545
14546 @end table
14547
14548 @node H8/500
14549 @subsection H8/500
14550
14551 @table @code
14552
14553 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14554 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14555 @item set memory @var{mod}
14556 @itemx show memory
14557 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14558 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14559 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14560 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14561
14562 @end table
14563
14564 @node M32R/D
14565 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14566
14567 @table @code
14568 @kindex target m32r
14569 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14570 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14571
14572 @kindex target m32rsdi
14573 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14574 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14575 @end table
14576
14577 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14578
14579 @table @code
14580 @item set download-path @var{path}
14581 @kindex set download-path
14582 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14583 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14584
14585 @item show download-path
14586 @kindex show download-path
14587 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14588
14589 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14590 @kindex set board-address
14591 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14592 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14593
14594 @item show board-address
14595 @kindex show board-address
14596 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14597
14598 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14599 @kindex set server-address
14600 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14601 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14602 host machine.
14603
14604 @item show server-address
14605 @kindex show server-address
14606 Display the IP address of the download server.
14607
14608 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14609 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14610 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14611 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14612 executable file is uploaded.
14613
14614 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14615 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14616 Test the @code{upload} command.
14617 @end table
14618
14619 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14620
14621 @table @code
14622 @item sdireset
14623 @kindex sdireset
14624 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14625 This command resets the SDI connection.
14626
14627 @item sdistatus
14628 @kindex sdistatus
14629 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14630
14631 @item debug_chaos
14632 @kindex debug_chaos
14633 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14634 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14635
14636 @item use_debug_dma
14637 @kindex use_debug_dma
14638 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14639
14640 @item use_mon_code
14641 @kindex use_mon_code
14642 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14643
14644 @item use_ib_break
14645 @kindex use_ib_break
14646 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14647
14648 @item use_dbt_break
14649 @kindex use_dbt_break
14650 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14651 @end table
14652
14653 @node M68K
14654 @subsection M68k
14655
14656 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14657 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14658
14659 @table @code
14660
14661 @kindex target abug
14662 @item target abug @var{dev}
14663 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14664
14665 @kindex target cpu32bug
14666 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14667 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14668
14669 @kindex target dbug
14670 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14671 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14672
14673 @kindex target est
14674 @item target est @var{dev}
14675 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14676
14677 @kindex target rom68k
14678 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14679 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14680
14681 @end table
14682
14683 @table @code
14684
14685 @kindex target rombug
14686 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14687 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14688
14689 @end table
14690
14691 @node MIPS Embedded
14692 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14693
14694 @cindex MIPS boards
14695 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14696 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14697 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14698
14699 @need 1000
14700 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14701
14702 @table @code
14703 @item target mips @var{port}
14704 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14705 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14706 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14707 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14708 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14709 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14710 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14711
14712 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14713 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14714 debugger:
14715
14716 @smallexample
14717 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14718 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14719 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14720 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14721 (@value{GDBP}) run
14722 @end smallexample
14723
14724 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14725 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14726 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14727 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14728 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14729
14730 @item target pmon @var{port}
14731 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14732 PMON ROM monitor.
14733
14734 @item target ddb @var{port}
14735 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14736 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14737
14738 @item target lsi @var{port}
14739 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14740 LSI variant of PMON.
14741
14742 @kindex target r3900
14743 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14744 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14745
14746 @kindex target array
14747 @item target array @var{dev}
14748 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14749
14750 @end table
14751
14752
14753 @noindent
14754 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14755
14756 @table @code
14757 @item set mipsfpu double
14758 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14759 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14760 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14761 @itemx show mipsfpu
14762 @kindex set mipsfpu
14763 @kindex show mipsfpu
14764 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14765 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14766 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14767 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14768 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14769 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14770 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14771 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14772 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14773 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14774 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14775 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14776 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14777
14778 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14779 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14780 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14781
14782 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14783 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14784
14785 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14786 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14787 @itemx show timeout
14788 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14789 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14790 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14791 @kindex set timeout
14792 @kindex show timeout
14793 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14794 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14795 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14796 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14797 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14798 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14799 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14800 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14801 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14802 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14803
14804 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14805 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14806 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14807 to run before stopping.
14808
14809 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14810 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14811 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14812 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14813 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14814 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14815
14816 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14817 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14818 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14819 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14820
14821 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14822 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14823 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14824 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14825 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14826 @table @asis
14827 @item pmon target
14828 @samp{PMON}
14829 @item ddb target
14830 @samp{NEC010}
14831 @item lsi target
14832 @samp{PMON>}
14833 @end table
14834
14835 @item show monitor-prompt
14836 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14837 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14838 remote monitor.
14839
14840 @item set monitor-warnings
14841 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14842 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14843 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14844 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14845 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14846
14847 @item show monitor-warnings
14848 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14849 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14850
14851 @item pmon @var{command}
14852 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14853 @cindex send PMON command
14854 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14855 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14856 @end table
14857
14858 @node OpenRISC 1000
14859 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14860 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14861
14862 @cindex or1k boards
14863 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14864 about platform and commands.
14865
14866 @table @code
14867
14868 @kindex target jtag
14869 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14870
14871 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14872 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14873 connected via parallel port to the board.
14874
14875 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14876
14877 @kindex or1ksim
14878 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14879 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14880 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14881
14882 @kindex info or1k spr
14883 @item info or1k spr
14884 Displays spr groups.
14885
14886 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14887 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14888 Displays register names in selected group.
14889
14890 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14891 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14892 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14893 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14894 Shows information about specified spr register.
14895
14896 @kindex spr
14897 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14898 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14899 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14900 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14901 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14902 @end table
14903
14904 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14905 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14906 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14907 triggers can be set using:
14908 @table @code
14909 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14910 Load effective address/data
14911 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14912 Store effective address/data
14913 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14914 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14915 @item $FETCH
14916 Fetch data
14917 @end table
14918
14919 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14920 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14921
14922 @code{htrace} commands:
14923 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14924 @table @code
14925 @kindex hwatch
14926 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14927 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14928 or Data. For example:
14929
14930 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14931
14932 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14933
14934 @kindex htrace
14935 @item htrace info
14936 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14937
14938 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14939 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14940
14941 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14942 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14943
14944 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14945 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14946
14947 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14948 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14949 triggered.
14950
14951 @item htrace enable
14952 @itemx htrace disable
14953 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14954
14955 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14956 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14957
14958 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14959 will be written there.
14960
14961 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14962 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14963
14964 @item htrace mode continuous
14965 Set continuous trace mode.
14966
14967 @item htrace mode suspend
14968 Set suspend trace mode.
14969
14970 @end table
14971
14972 @node PowerPC
14973 @subsection PowerPC
14974
14975 @table @code
14976 @kindex target dink32
14977 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14978 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14979
14980 @kindex target ppcbug
14981 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14982 @kindex target ppcbug1
14983 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14984 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14985
14986 @kindex target sds
14987 @item target sds @var{dev}
14988 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @cindex SDS protocol
14992 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14993 by@value{GDBN}:
14994
14995 @table @code
14996 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14997 @kindex set sdstimeout
14998 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14999 default is 2 seconds.
15000
15001 @item show sdstimeout
15002 @kindex show sdstimeout
15003 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15004
15005 @item sds @var{command}
15006 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15007 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15008 @end table
15009
15010
15011 @node PA
15012 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15013
15014 @table @code
15015
15016 @kindex target op50n
15017 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15018 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15019
15020 @kindex target w89k
15021 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15022 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15023
15024 @end table
15025
15026 @node SH
15027 @subsection Renesas SH
15028
15029 @table @code
15030
15031 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15032 @item target hms @var{dev}
15033 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15034 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15035 the communications speed used.
15036
15037 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15038 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15039 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15040
15041 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15042 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15043 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15044 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15045 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15046
15047 @end table
15048
15049 @node Sparclet
15050 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15051
15052 @cindex Sparclet
15053
15054 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15055 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15056 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15057 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15058 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15059
15060 @table @code
15061 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15062 @kindex remotetimeout
15063 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15064 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15065 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15066 @end table
15067
15068 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15069 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15070 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15071 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15072 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15073
15074 @smallexample
15075 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15076 @end smallexample
15077
15078 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15079
15080 @smallexample
15081 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15082 @end smallexample
15083
15084 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15085 Once you have set
15086 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15087 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15088 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15089
15090 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15091
15092 @smallexample
15093 (gdbslet)
15094 @end smallexample
15095
15096 @menu
15097 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15098 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15099 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15100 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15101 @end menu
15102
15103 @node Sparclet File
15104 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15105
15106 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15107
15108 @smallexample
15109 (gdbslet) file prog
15110 @end smallexample
15111
15112 @need 1000
15113 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15114 @value{GDBN} locates
15115 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15116 path.
15117 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15118 files will be searched as well.
15119 @value{GDBN} locates
15120 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15121 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15122 If it fails
15123 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15124
15125 @smallexample
15126 prog: No such file or directory.
15127 @end smallexample
15128
15129 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15130 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15131 @code{target} command again.
15132
15133 @node Sparclet Connection
15134 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15135
15136 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15137 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15138
15139 @smallexample
15140 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15141 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15142 main () at ../prog.c:3
15143 @end smallexample
15144
15145 @need 750
15146 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15147
15148 @smallexample
15149 Connected to ttya.
15150 @end smallexample
15151
15152 @node Sparclet Download
15153 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15154
15155 @cindex download to Sparclet
15156 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15157 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15158 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15159 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15160 command.
15161 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15162 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15163 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15164 of each of the file's sections.
15165 For instance, if the program
15166 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15167 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15171 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15172 @end smallexample
15173
15174 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15175 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15176 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15177
15178 @node Sparclet Execution
15179 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15180
15181 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15182 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15183 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15184 manual for the list of commands.
15185
15186 @smallexample
15187 (gdbslet) b main
15188 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15189 (gdbslet) run
15190 Starting program: prog
15191 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15192 3 char *symarg = 0;
15193 (gdbslet) step
15194 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15195 (gdbslet)
15196 @end smallexample
15197
15198 @node Sparclite
15199 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15200
15201 @table @code
15202
15203 @kindex target sparclite
15204 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15205 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15206 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15207 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15208 remote protocol.
15209
15210 @end table
15211
15212 @node ST2000
15213 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15214
15215 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15216 STDBUG protocol.
15217
15218 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15219 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15220
15221 @smallexample
15222 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15223 @end smallexample
15224
15225 @noindent
15226 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15227 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15228 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15229 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15230 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15231
15232 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15233 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15234 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15235 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15236 available on your host computer.
15237 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15238 @c basically hearsay.
15239
15240 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15241 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15242 environment:
15243
15244 @table @code
15245 @item st2000 @var{command}
15246 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15247 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15248 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15249 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15250 manual for available commands.
15251
15252 @item connect
15253 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15254 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15255 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15256 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15257 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15258 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15259 @end table
15260
15261 @node Z8000
15262 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15263
15264 @cindex Z8000
15265 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15266 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15267
15268 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15269 a Z8000 simulator.
15270
15271 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15272 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15273 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15274 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15275
15276 @table @code
15277 @item target sim @var{args}
15278 @kindex sim
15279 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15280 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15281 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15282 @end table
15283
15284 @noindent
15285 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15286 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15287 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15288 to run your program, and so on.
15289
15290 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15291 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15292 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15293
15294 @table @code
15295
15296 @item cycles
15297 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15298
15299 @item insts
15300 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15301
15302 @item time
15303 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15304
15305 @end table
15306
15307 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15308 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15309 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15310 simulated clock ticks.
15311
15312 @node AVR
15313 @subsection Atmel AVR
15314 @cindex AVR
15315
15316 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15317 following AVR-specific commands:
15318
15319 @table @code
15320 @item info io_registers
15321 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15322 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15323 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15324 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15325 @end table
15326
15327 @node CRIS
15328 @subsection CRIS
15329 @cindex CRIS
15330
15331 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15332 following CRIS-specific commands:
15333
15334 @table @code
15335 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15336 @cindex CRIS version
15337 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15338 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15339 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15340
15341 @item show cris-version
15342 Show the current CRIS version.
15343
15344 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15345 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15346 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15347 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15348 @code{R59}.
15349
15350 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15351 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15352
15353 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15354 @cindex CRIS mode
15355 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15356 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15357 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15358
15359 @item show cris-mode
15360 Show the current CRIS mode.
15361 @end table
15362
15363 @node Super-H
15364 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15365 @cindex Super-H
15366
15367 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15368 commands:
15369
15370 @table @code
15371 @item regs
15372 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15373 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15374 @end table
15375
15376 @node WinCE
15377 @subsection Windows CE
15378 @cindex Windows CE
15379
15380 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15381
15382 @table @code
15383 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15384 @kindex set remotedirectory
15385 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15386 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15387 drive.
15388
15389 @item show remotedirectory
15390 @kindex show remotedirectory
15391 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15392
15393 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15394 @kindex set remoteupload
15395 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15396 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15397 The default is @samp{newer}.
15398
15399 @item show remoteupload
15400 @kindex show remoteupload
15401 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15402
15403 @item set remoteaddhost
15404 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15405 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15406 arguments when you debug over a network.
15407
15408 @item show remoteaddhost
15409 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15410 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15411 debugging over a network.
15412 @end table
15413
15414
15415 @node Architectures
15416 @section Architectures
15417
15418 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15419 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15420
15421 @menu
15422 * i386::
15423 * A29K::
15424 * Alpha::
15425 * MIPS::
15426 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15427 @end menu
15428
15429 @node i386
15430 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15431
15432 @table @code
15433 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15434 @kindex set struct-convention
15435 @cindex struct return convention
15436 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15437 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15438 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15439 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15440 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15441 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15442 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15443 be returned in a register.
15444
15445 @item show struct-convention
15446 @kindex show struct-convention
15447 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15448 from functions.
15449 @end table
15450
15451 @node A29K
15452 @subsection A29K
15453
15454 @table @code
15455
15456 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15457 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15458 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15459 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15460 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15461 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15462 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15463 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15464 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15465 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15466 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15467 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15468 hexadecimal.
15469
15470 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15471 @item show rstack_high_address
15472 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15473 processors.
15474
15475 @end table
15476
15477 @node Alpha
15478 @subsection Alpha
15479
15480 See the following section.
15481
15482 @node MIPS
15483 @subsection MIPS
15484
15485 @cindex stack on Alpha
15486 @cindex stack on MIPS
15487 @cindex Alpha stack
15488 @cindex MIPS stack
15489 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15490 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15491 find the beginning of a function.
15492
15493 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15494 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15495 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15496 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15497 commands:
15498
15499 @table @code
15500 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15501 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15502 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15503 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15504 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15505 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15506 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15507 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15508
15509 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15510 Display the current limit.
15511 @end table
15512
15513 @noindent
15514 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15515 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15516
15517 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15518 programs:
15519
15520 @table @code
15521 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15522 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15523 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15524 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15525 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15526
15527 @table @samp
15528 @item 32
15529 32-bit GP registers
15530 @item 64
15531 64-bit GP registers
15532 @item auto
15533 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15534 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15535 @end table
15536
15537 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15538 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15539 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15540
15541 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15542 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15543 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15544 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15545 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15546 (the default).
15547
15548 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15549 @kindex set mips abi
15550 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15551 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15552 values of @var{arg} are:
15553
15554 @table @samp
15555 @item auto
15556 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15557 default).
15558 @item o32
15559 @item o64
15560 @item n32
15561 @item n64
15562 @item eabi32
15563 @item eabi64
15564 @item auto
15565 @end table
15566
15567 @item show mips abi
15568 @kindex show mips abi
15569 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15570
15571 @item set mipsfpu
15572 @itemx show mipsfpu
15573 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15574
15575 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15576 @kindex set mips mask-address
15577 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15578 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15579 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15580 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15581 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15582
15583 @item show mips mask-address
15584 @kindex show mips mask-address
15585 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15586 not.
15587
15588 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15589 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15590 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15591 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15592 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15593 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15594
15595 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15596 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15597 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15598
15599 @item set debug mips
15600 @kindex set debug mips
15601 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15602 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15603
15604 @item show debug mips
15605 @kindex show debug mips
15606 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15607 @end table
15608
15609
15610 @node HPPA
15611 @subsection HPPA
15612 @cindex HPPA support
15613
15614 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15615 following special commands:
15616
15617 @table @code
15618 @item set debug hppa
15619 @kindex set debug hppa
15620 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15621 messages are to be displayed.
15622
15623 @item show debug hppa
15624 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15625
15626 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15627 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15628 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15629 given @var{address}.
15630
15631 @end table
15632
15633
15634 @node Controlling GDB
15635 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15636
15637 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15638 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15639 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15640 described here.
15641
15642 @menu
15643 * Prompt:: Prompt
15644 * Editing:: Command editing
15645 * Command History:: Command history
15646 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15647 * Numbers:: Numbers
15648 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15649 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15650 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15651 @end menu
15652
15653 @node Prompt
15654 @section Prompt
15655
15656 @cindex prompt
15657
15658 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15659 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15660 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15661 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15662 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15663 which one you are talking to.
15664
15665 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15666 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15667 or a prompt that does not.
15668
15669 @table @code
15670 @kindex set prompt
15671 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15672 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15673
15674 @kindex show prompt
15675 @item show prompt
15676 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15677 @end table
15678
15679 @node Editing
15680 @section Command editing
15681 @cindex readline
15682 @cindex command line editing
15683
15684 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15685 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15686 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15687 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15688 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15689 debugging sessions.
15690
15691 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15692 command @code{set}.
15693
15694 @table @code
15695 @kindex set editing
15696 @cindex editing
15697 @item set editing
15698 @itemx set editing on
15699 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15700
15701 @item set editing off
15702 Disable command line editing.
15703
15704 @kindex show editing
15705 @item show editing
15706 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15707 @end table
15708
15709 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15710 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15711 encouraged to read that chapter.
15712
15713 @node Command History
15714 @section Command history
15715 @cindex command history
15716
15717 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15718 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15719 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15720 history facility.
15721
15722 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15723 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15724 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15725
15726 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15727 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15728 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15729 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15730 pressed on a line by itself.
15731
15732 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15733 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15734 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15735 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15736
15737 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15738 history.
15739
15740 @table @code
15741 @cindex history substitution
15742 @cindex history file
15743 @kindex set history filename
15744 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15745 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15746 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15747 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15748 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15749 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15750 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15751 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15752 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15753 is not set.
15754
15755 @cindex save command history
15756 @kindex set history save
15757 @item set history save
15758 @itemx set history save on
15759 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15760 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15761
15762 @item set history save off
15763 Stop recording command history in a file.
15764
15765 @cindex history size
15766 @kindex set history size
15767 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15768 @item set history size @var{size}
15769 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15770 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15771 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15772 @end table
15773
15774 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15775 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15776
15777 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15778 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15779 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15780 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15781 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15782 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15783 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15784 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15785
15786 The commands to control history expansion are:
15787
15788 @table @code
15789 @item set history expansion on
15790 @itemx set history expansion
15791 @kindex set history expansion
15792 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15793
15794 @item set history expansion off
15795 Disable history expansion.
15796
15797 @c @group
15798 @kindex show history
15799 @item show history
15800 @itemx show history filename
15801 @itemx show history save
15802 @itemx show history size
15803 @itemx show history expansion
15804 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15805 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15806 @c @end group
15807 @end table
15808
15809 @table @code
15810 @kindex show commands
15811 @cindex show last commands
15812 @cindex display command history
15813 @item show commands
15814 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15815
15816 @item show commands @var{n}
15817 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15818
15819 @item show commands +
15820 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15821 @end table
15822
15823 @node Screen Size
15824 @section Screen size
15825 @cindex size of screen
15826 @cindex pauses in output
15827
15828 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15829 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15830 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15831 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15832 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15833 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15834 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15835 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15836
15837 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15838 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15839 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15840 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15841 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15842 width} commands:
15843
15844 @table @code
15845 @kindex set height
15846 @kindex set width
15847 @kindex show width
15848 @kindex show height
15849 @item set height @var{lpp}
15850 @itemx show height
15851 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15852 @itemx show width
15853 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15854 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15855 commands display the current settings.
15856
15857 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15858 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15859 file or to an editor buffer.
15860
15861 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15862 from wrapping its output.
15863
15864 @item set pagination on
15865 @itemx set pagination off
15866 @kindex set pagination
15867 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15868 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15869
15870 @item show pagination
15871 @kindex show pagination
15872 Show the current pagination mode.
15873 @end table
15874
15875 @node Numbers
15876 @section Numbers
15877 @cindex number representation
15878 @cindex entering numbers
15879
15880 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15881 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15882 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15883 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15884 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15885 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15886 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15887 both input and output with the commands described below.
15888
15889 @table @code
15890 @kindex set input-radix
15891 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15892 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15893 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15894 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15895 example, any of
15896
15897 @smallexample
15898 set input-radix 012
15899 set input-radix 10.
15900 set input-radix 0xa
15901 @end smallexample
15902
15903 @noindent
15904 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15905 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15906 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15907 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15908 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15909 change the radix.
15910
15911 @kindex set output-radix
15912 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15913 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15914 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15915 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15916
15917 @kindex show input-radix
15918 @item show input-radix
15919 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15920
15921 @kindex show output-radix
15922 @item show output-radix
15923 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15924
15925 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15926 @itemx show radix
15927 @kindex set radix
15928 @kindex show radix
15929 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15930 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15931 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15932 default value of 10.
15933
15934 @end table
15935
15936 @node ABI
15937 @section Configuring the current ABI
15938
15939 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15940 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15941 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15942 current ABI.
15943
15944 @cindex OS ABI
15945 @kindex set osabi
15946 @kindex show osabi
15947
15948 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15949 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15950 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15951 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15952 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15953 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15954 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15955 platform provides.
15956
15957 @table @code
15958 @item show osabi
15959 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15960
15961 @item set osabi
15962 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15963
15964 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15965 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15966 @end table
15967
15968 @cindex float promotion
15969
15970 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15971 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15972 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15973 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15974 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15975 @code{double} and then passed.
15976
15977 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15978 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15979 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15980
15981 @table @code
15982 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15983 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15984 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15985 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15986 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15987
15988 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15989 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15990 functions.
15991
15992 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15993 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15994 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15995 @end table
15996
15997 @kindex set cp-abi
15998 @kindex show cp-abi
15999 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16000 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16001 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16002 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16003 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16004 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16005 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16006 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16007 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16008 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16009 ``auto''.
16010
16011 @table @code
16012 @item show cp-abi
16013 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16014
16015 @item set cp-abi
16016 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16017
16018 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16019 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16020 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16021 @end table
16022
16023 @node Messages/Warnings
16024 @section Optional warnings and messages
16025
16026 @cindex verbose operation
16027 @cindex optional warnings
16028 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16029 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16030 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16031 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16032
16033 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16034 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16035 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16036
16037 @table @code
16038 @kindex set verbose
16039 @item set verbose on
16040 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16041
16042 @item set verbose off
16043 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16044
16045 @kindex show verbose
16046 @item show verbose
16047 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16048 @end table
16049
16050 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16051 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16052 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16053 symbol files}).
16054
16055 @table @code
16056
16057 @kindex set complaints
16058 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16059 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16060 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16061 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16062 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16063
16064 @kindex show complaints
16065 @item show complaints
16066 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16067
16068 @end table
16069
16070 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16071 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16072 you try to run a program which is already running:
16073
16074 @smallexample
16075 (@value{GDBP}) run
16076 The program being debugged has been started already.
16077 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16078 @end smallexample
16079
16080 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16081 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16082
16083 @table @code
16084
16085 @kindex set confirm
16086 @cindex flinching
16087 @cindex confirmation
16088 @cindex stupid questions
16089 @item set confirm off
16090 Disables confirmation requests.
16091
16092 @item set confirm on
16093 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16094
16095 @kindex show confirm
16096 @item show confirm
16097 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16098
16099 @end table
16100
16101 @cindex command tracing
16102 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16103 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16104 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16105 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16106
16107 @table @code
16108 @kindex set trace-commands
16109 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16110 @item set trace-commands on
16111 Enable command tracing.
16112 @item set trace-commands off
16113 Disable command tracing.
16114 @item show trace-commands
16115 Display the current state of command tracing.
16116 @end table
16117
16118 @node Debugging Output
16119 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16120 @cindex optional debugging messages
16121
16122 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16123 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16124 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16125 section documents those commands.
16126
16127 @table @code
16128 @kindex set exec-done-display
16129 @item set exec-done-display
16130 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16131 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16132 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16133 @kindex show exec-done-display
16134 @item show exec-done-display
16135 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16136 notification.
16137 @kindex set debug
16138 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16139 @cindex architecture debugging info
16140 @item set debug arch
16141 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16142 @kindex show debug
16143 @item show debug arch
16144 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16145 @item set debug aix-thread
16146 @cindex AIX threads
16147 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16148 module.
16149 @item show debug aix-thread
16150 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16151 @item set debug event
16152 @cindex event debugging info
16153 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16154 default is off.
16155 @item show debug event
16156 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16157 info.
16158 @item set debug expression
16159 @cindex expression debugging info
16160 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16161 expression parsing. The default is off.
16162 @item show debug expression
16163 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16164 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16165 @item set debug frame
16166 @cindex frame debugging info
16167 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16168 default is off.
16169 @item show debug frame
16170 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16171 info.
16172 @item set debug infrun
16173 @cindex inferior debugging info
16174 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16175 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16176 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16177 @item show debug infrun
16178 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16179 @item set debug lin-lwp
16180 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16181 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16182 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16183 @item show debug lin-lwp
16184 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16185 @item set debug observer
16186 @cindex observer debugging info
16187 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16188 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16189 @item show debug observer
16190 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16191 @item set debug overload
16192 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16193 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16194 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16195 is off.
16196 @item show debug overload
16197 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16198 debugging info.
16199 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16200 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16201 @cindex debug remote protocol
16202 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16203 @cindex display remote packets
16204 @item set debug remote
16205 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16206 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16207 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16208 @item show debug remote
16209 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16210 @item set debug serial
16211 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16212 default is off.
16213 @item show debug serial
16214 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16215 info.
16216 @item set debug solib-frv
16217 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16218 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16219 @item show debug solib-frv
16220 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16221 messages.
16222 @item set debug target
16223 @cindex target debugging info
16224 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16225 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16226 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16227 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16228 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16229 @item show debug target
16230 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16231 info.
16232 @item set debugvarobj
16233 @cindex variable object debugging info
16234 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16235 info. The default is off.
16236 @item show debugvarobj
16237 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16238 debugging info.
16239 @end table
16240
16241 @node Sequences
16242 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16243
16244 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16245 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16246 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16247 files.
16248
16249 @menu
16250 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16251 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16252 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16253 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16254 @end menu
16255
16256 @node Define
16257 @section User-defined commands
16258
16259 @cindex user-defined command
16260 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16261 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16262 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16263 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16264 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16265 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16266
16267 @smallexample
16268 define adder
16269 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16270 end
16271 @end smallexample
16272
16273 @noindent
16274 To execute the command use:
16275
16276 @smallexample
16277 adder 1 2 3
16278 @end smallexample
16279
16280 @noindent
16281 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16282 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16283 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16284 functions calls.
16285
16286 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16287 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16288 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16289 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 define adder
16293 if $argc == 2
16294 print $arg0 + $arg1
16295 end
16296 if $argc == 3
16297 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16298 end
16299 end
16300 @end smallexample
16301
16302 @table @code
16303
16304 @kindex define
16305 @item define @var{commandname}
16306 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16307 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16308
16309 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16310 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16311 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16312
16313 @kindex document
16314 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16315 @item document @var{commandname}
16316 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16317 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16318 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16319 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16320 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16321 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16322
16323 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16324 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16325 does not change the documentation.
16326
16327 @kindex dont-repeat
16328 @cindex don't repeat command
16329 @item dont-repeat
16330 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16331 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16332 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16333
16334 @kindex help user-defined
16335 @item help user-defined
16336 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16337 (if any) for each.
16338
16339 @kindex show user
16340 @item show user
16341 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16342 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16343 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16344 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16345
16346 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16347 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16348 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16349 @item show max-user-call-depth
16350 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16351 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16352 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16353 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16354 @end table
16355
16356 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16357 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16358
16359 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16360 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16361 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16362
16363 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16364 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16365 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16366 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16367
16368 @node Hooks
16369 @section User-defined command hooks
16370 @cindex command hooks
16371 @cindex hooks, for commands
16372 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16373
16374 @kindex hook
16375 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16376 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16377 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16378 before that command.
16379
16380 @cindex hooks, post-command
16381 @kindex hookpost
16382 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16383 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16384 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16385 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16386 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16387
16388 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16389 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16390
16391 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16392 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16393
16394 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16395 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16396 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16397 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16398 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16399
16400 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16401 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16402 you could define:
16403
16404 @smallexample
16405 define hook-stop
16406 handle SIGALRM nopass
16407 end
16408
16409 define hook-run
16410 handle SIGALRM pass
16411 end
16412
16413 define hook-continue
16414 handle SIGLARM pass
16415 end
16416 @end smallexample
16417
16418 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16419 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16420 you could define:
16421
16422 @smallexample
16423 define hook-echo
16424 echo <<<---
16425 end
16426
16427 define hookpost-echo
16428 echo --->>>\n
16429 end
16430
16431 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16432 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16433 (@value{GDBP})
16434
16435 @end smallexample
16436
16437 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16438 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16439 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16440 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16441 @c or not?
16442 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16443 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16444 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16445
16446 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16447 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16448
16449 @node Command Files
16450 @section Command files
16451
16452 @cindex command files
16453 @cindex scripting commands
16454 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16455 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16456 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16457 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16458 terminal.
16459
16460 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16461 command:
16462
16463 @table @code
16464 @kindex source
16465 @cindex execute commands from a file
16466 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16467 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16468 @end table
16469
16470 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16471 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16472 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16473 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16474 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16475
16476 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16477 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16478
16479 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16480 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16481 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16482
16483 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16484 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16485 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16486 when called from command files.
16487
16488 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16489 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16490 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16491 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16492 the next command.
16493
16494 @smallexample
16495 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16496 @end smallexample
16497
16498 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16499 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16500 would be directed to @file{log}.
16501
16502 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16503 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16504 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16505 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16506 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16507 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16508 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16509 conditionally, etc.
16510
16511 @table @code
16512 @kindex if
16513 @kindex else
16514 @item if
16515 @itemx else
16516 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16517 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16518 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16519 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16520 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16521 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16522 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16523
16524 @kindex while
16525 @item while
16526 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16527 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16528 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16529 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16530 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16531 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16532
16533 @kindex loop_break
16534 @item loop_break
16535 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16536 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16537 line.
16538
16539 @kindex loop_continue
16540 @item loop_continue
16541 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16542 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16543 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16544 the controlling expression.
16545
16546 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16547 @item end
16548 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16549 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16550 @end table
16551
16552
16553 @node Output
16554 @section Commands for controlled output
16555
16556 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16557 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16558 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16559 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16560 want.
16561
16562 @table @code
16563 @kindex echo
16564 @item echo @var{text}
16565 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16566 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16567 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16568 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16569 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16570 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16571 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16572 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16573 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16574 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16575 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16576
16577 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16578 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16579
16580 @smallexample
16581 echo This is some text\n\
16582 which is continued\n\
16583 onto several lines.\n
16584 @end smallexample
16585
16586 produces the same output as
16587
16588 @smallexample
16589 echo This is some text\n
16590 echo which is continued\n
16591 echo onto several lines.\n
16592 @end smallexample
16593
16594 @kindex output
16595 @item output @var{expression}
16596 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16597 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16598 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16599 on expressions.
16600
16601 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16602 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16603 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16604 formats}, for more information.
16605
16606 @kindex printf
16607 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16608 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16609 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16610 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16611 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16612 subroutine
16613 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16614 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16615 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16616 @c supported.
16617
16618 @smallexample
16619 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16620 @end smallexample
16621
16622 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16623
16624 @smallexample
16625 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16626 @end smallexample
16627
16628 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16629 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16630 letter.
16631 @end table
16632
16633 @node Interpreters
16634 @chapter Command Interpreters
16635 @cindex command interpreters
16636
16637 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16638 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16639 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16640
16641 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16642 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16643 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16644 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16645
16646 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16647 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16648 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16649 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16650
16651 @table @code
16652 @item console
16653 @cindex console interpreter
16654 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16655 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16656 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16657
16658 @item mi
16659 @cindex mi interpreter
16660 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16661 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16662 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16663 Interface}.
16664
16665 @item mi2
16666 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16667 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16668
16669 @item mi1
16670 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16671 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16672
16673 @end table
16674
16675 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16676 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16677 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16678 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16679 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16680 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16681 the IDE inoperable!
16682
16683 @kindex interpreter-exec
16684 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16685 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16686 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16687 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16688
16689 @smallexample
16690 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16691 @end smallexample
16692
16693 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16694 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16695
16696 @node TUI
16697 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16698 @cindex TUI
16699 @cindex Text User Interface
16700
16701 @menu
16702 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16703 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16704 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16705 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16706 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16707 @end menu
16708
16709 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16710 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16711 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16712 commands in separate text windows.
16713
16714 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16715 @pindex gdbtui
16716 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16717
16718 @node TUI Overview
16719 @section TUI overview
16720
16721 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16722 @value{GDBN} runs:
16723
16724 @itemize @bullet
16725 @item
16726 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16727 windows on the terminal.
16728
16729 @item
16730 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16731 the TUI.
16732 @end itemize
16733
16734 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16735 on the terminal:
16736
16737 @table @emph
16738 @item command
16739 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16740 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16741 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16742 window is always visible.
16743
16744 @item source
16745 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16746 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16747
16748 @item assembly
16749 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16750
16751 @item register
16752 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16753 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16754 changed are highlighted.
16755
16756 @end table
16757
16758 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16759 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16760 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16761 indicates the breakpoint type:
16762
16763 @table @code
16764 @item B
16765 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16766
16767 @item b
16768 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16769
16770 @item H
16771 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16772
16773 @item h
16774 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16775
16776 @end table
16777
16778 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16779
16780 @table @code
16781 @item +
16782 Breakpoint is enabled.
16783
16784 @item -
16785 Breakpoint is disabled.
16786
16787 @end table
16788
16789 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16790 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16791 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16792 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16793 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16794 The following layouts are available:
16795
16796 @itemize @bullet
16797 @item
16798 source
16799
16800 @item
16801 assembly
16802
16803 @item
16804 source and assembly
16805
16806 @item
16807 source and registers
16808
16809 @item
16810 assembly and registers
16811
16812 @end itemize
16813
16814 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16815 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16816 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16817 are displayed:
16818
16819 @table @emph
16820 @item target
16821 Indicates the current gdb target
16822 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16823
16824 @item process
16825 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16826 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16827
16828 @item function
16829 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16830 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16831 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16832 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16833
16834 @item line
16835 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16836 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16837
16838 @item pc
16839 Indicates the current program counter address.
16840
16841 @end table
16842
16843 @node TUI Keys
16844 @section TUI Key Bindings
16845 @cindex TUI key bindings
16846
16847 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16848 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16849 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16850 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16851 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16852 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16853 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16854
16855 @table @kbd
16856 @kindex C-x C-a
16857 @item C-x C-a
16858 @kindex C-x a
16859 @itemx C-x a
16860 @kindex C-x A
16861 @itemx C-x A
16862 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16863 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16864 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16865 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16866 The screen is then refreshed.
16867
16868 @kindex C-x 1
16869 @item C-x 1
16870 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16871 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16872 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16873
16874 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16875
16876 @kindex C-x 2
16877 @item C-x 2
16878 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16879 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16880 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16881 previous layout and the new one.
16882
16883 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16884
16885 @kindex C-x o
16886 @item C-x o
16887 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16888 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16889 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16890
16891 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16892
16893 @kindex C-x s
16894 @item C-x s
16895 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16896 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16897
16898 @end table
16899
16900 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16901
16902 @table @key
16903 @kindex PgUp
16904 @item PgUp
16905 Scroll the active window one page up.
16906
16907 @kindex PgDn
16908 @item PgDn
16909 Scroll the active window one page down.
16910
16911 @kindex Up
16912 @item Up
16913 Scroll the active window one line up.
16914
16915 @kindex Down
16916 @item Down
16917 Scroll the active window one line down.
16918
16919 @kindex Left
16920 @item Left
16921 Scroll the active window one column left.
16922
16923 @kindex Right
16924 @item Right
16925 Scroll the active window one column right.
16926
16927 @kindex C-L
16928 @item C-L
16929 Refresh the screen.
16930
16931 @end table
16932
16933 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16934 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16935 active window is the command window. When the command window
16936 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16937 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
16938
16939 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16940 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16941 @cindex TUI single key mode
16942
16943 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16944 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16945 some gdb commands.
16946
16947 @table @kbd
16948 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16949 @item c
16950 continue
16951
16952 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16953 @item d
16954 down
16955
16956 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16957 @item f
16958 finish
16959
16960 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16961 @item n
16962 next
16963
16964 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16965 @item q
16966 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16967
16968 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16969 @item r
16970 run
16971
16972 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16973 @item s
16974 step
16975
16976 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16977 @item u
16978 up
16979
16980 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16981 @item v
16982 info locals
16983
16984 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16985 @item w
16986 where
16987
16988 @end table
16989
16990 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16991 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16992 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16993 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16994 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16995 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
16996
16997
16998 @node TUI Commands
16999 @section TUI specific commands
17000 @cindex TUI commands
17001
17002 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17003 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17004 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17005 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17006 in the TUI mode.
17007
17008 @table @code
17009 @item info win
17010 @kindex info win
17011 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17012
17013 @item layout next
17014 @kindex layout
17015 Display the next layout.
17016
17017 @item layout prev
17018 Display the previous layout.
17019
17020 @item layout src
17021 Display the source window only.
17022
17023 @item layout asm
17024 Display the assembly window only.
17025
17026 @item layout split
17027 Display the source and assembly window.
17028
17029 @item layout regs
17030 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17031
17032 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17033 @kindex focus
17034 Set the focus to the named window.
17035 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17036 can be affected to another window.
17037
17038 @item refresh
17039 @kindex refresh
17040 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
17041
17042 @item tui reg float
17043 @kindex tui reg
17044 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17045
17046 @item tui reg general
17047 Show the general registers in the register window.
17048
17049 @item tui reg next
17050 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17051 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17052 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17053 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17054
17055 @item tui reg system
17056 Show the system registers in the register window.
17057
17058 @item update
17059 @kindex update
17060 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17061
17062 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17063 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17064 @kindex winheight
17065 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17066 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17067 decrease it.
17068
17069 @item tabset
17070 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17071 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17072
17073 @end table
17074
17075 @node TUI Configuration
17076 @section TUI configuration variables
17077 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17078
17079 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17080 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17081
17082 @table @code
17083 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17084 @kindex set tui border-kind
17085 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17086 The possible values are the following:
17087 @table @code
17088 @item space
17089 Use a space character to draw the border.
17090
17091 @item ascii
17092 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17093
17094 @item acs
17095 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17096 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17097
17098 @end table
17099
17100 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17101 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17102 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17103 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17104 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17105
17106 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17107 @kindex set tui border-mode
17108 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17109 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17110 @table @code
17111 @item normal
17112 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17113
17114 @item standout
17115 Use standout mode.
17116
17117 @item reverse
17118 Use reverse video mode.
17119
17120 @item half
17121 Use half bright mode.
17122
17123 @item half-standout
17124 Use half bright and standout mode.
17125
17126 @item bold
17127 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17128
17129 @item bold-standout
17130 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17131
17132 @end table
17133
17134 @end table
17135
17136 @node Emacs
17137 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17138
17139 @cindex Emacs
17140 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17141 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17142 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17143 @value{GDBN}.
17144
17145 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17146 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17147 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17148 created Emacs buffer.
17149 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17150
17151 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17152 things:
17153
17154 @itemize @bullet
17155 @item
17156 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17157 @end itemize
17158
17159 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17160 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17161
17162 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17163 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17164 in this way.
17165
17166 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17167 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17168 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17169 stop.
17170
17171 @itemize @bullet
17172 @item
17173 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17174 @end itemize
17175
17176 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17177 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17178 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17179 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17180 and the source.
17181
17182 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17183 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17184
17185 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17186 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17187 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17188 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17189 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17190 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17191 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17192 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17193 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17194
17195 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17196 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17197 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17198 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17199
17200 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17201 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17202 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17203 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17204 one you want.
17205
17206 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17207 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17208
17209 @table @kbd
17210 @item C-h m
17211 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17212
17213 @item C-c C-s
17214 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17215 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17216
17217 @item C-c C-n
17218 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17219 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17220 to show the current file and location.
17221
17222 @item C-c C-i
17223 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17224 display window accordingly.
17225
17226 @item C-c C-f
17227 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17228 @code{finish} command.
17229
17230 @item C-c C-r
17231 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17232 command.
17233
17234 @item C-c <
17235 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17236 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17237 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17238
17239 @item C-c >
17240 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17241 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17242 @end table
17243
17244 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
17245 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17246
17247 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17248 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17249 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17250 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17251 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17252 current one.
17253
17254 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17255 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17256 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17257 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17258 frame.
17259
17260 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17261 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17262 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17263 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17264 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17265 to correspond properly with the code.
17266
17267 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17268 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17269 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17270
17271 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17272 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17273 @ignore
17274 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17275 @kindex Epoch
17276 @kindex inspect
17277
17278 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17279 called the @code{epoch}
17280 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17281 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17282 each value is printed in its own window.
17283 @end ignore
17284
17285
17286 @node GDB/MI
17287 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17288
17289 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17290
17291 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17292 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17293 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17294 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17295 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17296 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17297
17298 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17299 in the form of a reference manual.
17300
17301 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17302 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17303 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17304
17305 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17306
17307 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17308 This chapter uses the following notation:
17309
17310 @itemize @bullet
17311 @item
17312 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17313
17314 @item
17315 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17316 it may or may not be given.
17317
17318 @item
17319 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17320 may repeat zero or more times.
17321
17322 @item
17323 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17324 may repeat one or more times.
17325
17326 @item
17327 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17328 @end itemize
17329
17330 @ignore
17331 @heading Dependencies
17332 @end ignore
17333
17334 @menu
17335 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17336 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17337 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17338 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17339 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17340 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17341 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17342 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17343 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17344 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17345 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17346 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17347 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17348 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17349 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17350 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17351 @ignore
17352 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17353 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17354 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17355 @end ignore
17356 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17357 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17358 @end menu
17359
17360 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17361 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17362 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17363
17364 @menu
17365 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17366 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17367 @end menu
17368
17369 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17370 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17371
17372 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17373 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17374 @table @code
17375 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17376 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17377
17378 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17379 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17380 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17381
17382 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17383 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17384 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17385
17386 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17387 "any sequence of digits"
17388
17389 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17390 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17391
17392 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17393 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17394
17395 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17396 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17397
17398 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17399 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17400 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17401
17402 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17403 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17404
17405 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17406 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17407 @end table
17408
17409 @noindent
17410 Notes:
17411
17412 @itemize @bullet
17413 @item
17414 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17415 output is described below.
17416
17417 @item
17418 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17419 finishes.
17420
17421 @item
17422 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17423 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17424 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17425 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17426 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17427 @end itemize
17428
17429 Pragmatics:
17430
17431 @itemize @bullet
17432 @item
17433 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17434
17435 @item
17436 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17437 @end itemize
17438
17439 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17440 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17441
17442 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17443 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17444 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17445 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17446 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17447 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17448
17449 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17450 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17451 @var{token}.
17452
17453 @table @code
17454 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17455 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17456
17457 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17458 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17459
17460 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17461 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17462
17463 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17464 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17465
17466 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17467 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17468
17469 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17470 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17471
17472 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17473 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17474
17475 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17476 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17477
17478 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17479 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17480
17481 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17482 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17483 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17484
17485 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17486 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17487
17488 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17489 @code{ @var{string} }
17490
17491 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17492 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17493
17494 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17495 @code{@var{c-string}}
17496
17497 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17498 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17499
17500 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17501 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17502 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17503
17504 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17505 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17506
17507 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17508 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17509
17510 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17511 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17512
17513 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17514 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17515
17516 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17517 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17518
17519 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17520 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17521 @end table
17522
17523 @noindent
17524 Notes:
17525
17526 @itemize @bullet
17527 @item
17528 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17529
17530 @item
17531 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17532 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17533 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17534 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17535
17536 @item
17537 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17538 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17539 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17540 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17541
17542 @item
17543 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17544 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17545 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17546 @samp{*}.
17547
17548 @item
17549 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17550 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17551 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17552 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17553
17554 @item
17555 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17556 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17557 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17558 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17559
17560 @item
17561 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17562 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17563 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17564
17565 @item
17566 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17567 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17568 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17569 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17570
17571 @item
17572 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17573 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17574 @var{values}.
17575
17576
17577 @end itemize
17578
17579 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17580 details about the various output records.
17581
17582 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17583 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17584 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17585
17586 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17587 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17588
17589 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17590 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17591 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17592 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17593 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17594 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17595
17596 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17597 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17598 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17599
17600 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17601 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17602 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17603 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17604
17605 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17606 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17607
17608 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17609 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17610 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17611 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17612 might change.
17613
17614 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17615 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17616 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17617 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17618
17619 @itemize @bullet
17620 @item
17621 New MI commands may be added.
17622
17623 @item
17624 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17625
17626 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17627 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17628
17629 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17630 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17631 @end itemize
17632
17633 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17634 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17635 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17636 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17637 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17638
17639 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17640 @c version?
17641
17642 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17643 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17644 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17645 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17646 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17647 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17648 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17649 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17650 @cindex mailing lists
17651
17652 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17653 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17654 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17655
17656 @menu
17657 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17658 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17659 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17660 @end menu
17661
17662 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17663 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17664
17665 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17666 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17667 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17668 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17669
17670 @table @code
17671 @findex ^done
17672 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17673 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17674 values.
17675
17676 @item "^running"
17677 @findex ^running
17678 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17679 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17680 running.
17681
17682 @item "^connected"
17683 @findex ^connected
17684 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17685
17686 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17687 @findex ^error
17688 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17689 error message.
17690
17691 @item "^exit"
17692 @findex ^exit
17693 GDB has terminated.
17694
17695 @end table
17696
17697 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17698 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17699
17700 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17701 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17702 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17703 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17704 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17705
17706 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17707 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17708 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17709 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17710 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17711
17712 @table @code
17713 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17714 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17715 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17716
17717 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17718 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17719 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17720 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17721
17722 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17723 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17724 internals.
17725 @end table
17726
17727 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17728 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17729
17730 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17731 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17732 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17733 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17734 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17735 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17736
17737 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17738 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17739
17740 @table @code
17741 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17742 @end table
17743
17744 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17745
17746 @table @code
17747 @item breakpoint-hit
17748 A breakpoint was reached.
17749 @item watchpoint-trigger
17750 A watchpoint was triggered.
17751 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17752 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17753 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17754 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17755 @item function-finished
17756 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17757 @item location-reached
17758 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17759 @item watchpoint-scope
17760 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17761 @item end-stepping-range
17762 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17763 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17764 @item exited-signalled
17765 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17766 @item exited
17767 The inferior exited.
17768 @item exited-normally
17769 The inferior exited normally.
17770 @item signal-received
17771 A signal was received by the inferior.
17772 @end table
17773
17774
17775 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17776 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17777 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17778 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17779
17780 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17781 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17782 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17783 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17784
17785 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17786 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17787
17788 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17789
17790 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17791 information of the breakpoint.
17792
17793 @smallexample
17794 -> -break-insert main
17795 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17796 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17797 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17798 <- (gdb)
17799 @end smallexample
17800
17801 @subheading Program Execution
17802
17803 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17804 reason that execution stopped.
17805
17806 @smallexample
17807 -> -exec-run
17808 <- ^running
17809 <- (gdb)
17810 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17811 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17812 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17813 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17814 <- (gdb)
17815 -> -exec-continue
17816 <- ^running
17817 <- (gdb)
17818 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17819 <- (gdb)
17820 @end smallexample
17821
17822 @subheading Quitting GDB
17823
17824 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 -> (gdb)
17828 <- -gdb-exit
17829 <- ^exit
17830 @end smallexample
17831
17832 @subheading A Bad Command
17833
17834 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17835
17836 @smallexample
17837 -> -rubbish
17838 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17839 <- (gdb)
17840 @end smallexample
17841
17842
17843 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17844 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17845 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17846
17847 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17848 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17849
17850 @subheading Motivation
17851
17852 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17853
17854 @subheading Introduction
17855
17856 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17857
17858 @subheading Commands
17859
17860 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17861
17862 @subsubheading Synopsis
17863
17864 @smallexample
17865 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17866 @end smallexample
17867
17868 @subsubheading Result
17869
17870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17871
17872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17873
17874 @subsubheading Example
17875
17876 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17877 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17878
17879
17880 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17881 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17882 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17883
17884 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17885 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17886 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17887 breakpoints.
17888
17889 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17890 @findex -break-after
17891
17892 @subsubheading Synopsis
17893
17894 @smallexample
17895 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17896 @end smallexample
17897
17898 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17899 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17900 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17901 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17902
17903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17904
17905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17906
17907 @subsubheading Example
17908
17909 @smallexample
17910 (gdb)
17911 -break-insert main
17912 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17913 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17914 (gdb)
17915 -break-after 1 3
17916 ~
17917 ^done
17918 (gdb)
17919 -break-list
17920 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17921 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17922 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17923 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17924 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17925 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17926 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17927 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17928 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17929 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17930 (gdb)
17931 @end smallexample
17932
17933 @ignore
17934 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17935 @findex -break-catch
17936
17937 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17938 @findex -break-commands
17939 @end ignore
17940
17941
17942 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17943 @findex -break-condition
17944
17945 @subsubheading Synopsis
17946
17947 @smallexample
17948 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17949 @end smallexample
17950
17951 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17952 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17953 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17954 command below).
17955
17956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17957
17958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17959
17960 @subsubheading Example
17961
17962 @smallexample
17963 (gdb)
17964 -break-condition 1 1
17965 ^done
17966 (gdb)
17967 -break-list
17968 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17969 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17970 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17971 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17972 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17973 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17974 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17975 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17976 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17977 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17978 (gdb)
17979 @end smallexample
17980
17981 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17982 @findex -break-delete
17983
17984 @subsubheading Synopsis
17985
17986 @smallexample
17987 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17988 @end smallexample
17989
17990 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17991 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17992
17993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17994
17995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17996
17997 @subsubheading Example
17998
17999 @smallexample
18000 (gdb)
18001 -break-delete 1
18002 ^done
18003 (gdb)
18004 -break-list
18005 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18006 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18007 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18008 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18009 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18010 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18011 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18012 body=[]@}
18013 (gdb)
18014 @end smallexample
18015
18016 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18017 @findex -break-disable
18018
18019 @subsubheading Synopsis
18020
18021 @smallexample
18022 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18023 @end smallexample
18024
18025 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18026 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18027
18028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18029
18030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18031
18032 @subsubheading Example
18033
18034 @smallexample
18035 (gdb)
18036 -break-disable 2
18037 ^done
18038 (gdb)
18039 -break-list
18040 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18041 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18042 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18043 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18044 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18045 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18046 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18047 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18048 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18049 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18050 (gdb)
18051 @end smallexample
18052
18053 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18054 @findex -break-enable
18055
18056 @subsubheading Synopsis
18057
18058 @smallexample
18059 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18060 @end smallexample
18061
18062 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18063
18064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18065
18066 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18067
18068 @subsubheading Example
18069
18070 @smallexample
18071 (gdb)
18072 -break-enable 2
18073 ^done
18074 (gdb)
18075 -break-list
18076 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18077 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18078 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18079 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18080 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18081 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18082 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18083 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18084 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18085 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18086 (gdb)
18087 @end smallexample
18088
18089 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18090 @findex -break-info
18091
18092 @subsubheading Synopsis
18093
18094 @smallexample
18095 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18096 @end smallexample
18097
18098 @c REDUNDANT???
18099 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18100
18101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18102
18103 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18104
18105 @subsubheading Example
18106 N.A.
18107
18108 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18109 @findex -break-insert
18110
18111 @subsubheading Synopsis
18112
18113 @smallexample
18114 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18115 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18116 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 @noindent
18120 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18121
18122 @itemize @bullet
18123 @item function
18124 @c @item +offset
18125 @c @item -offset
18126 @c @item linenum
18127 @item filename:linenum
18128 @item filename:function
18129 @item *address
18130 @end itemize
18131
18132 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18133
18134 @table @samp
18135 @item -t
18136 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18137 @item -h
18138 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18139 @item -c @var{condition}
18140 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18141 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18142 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18143 @item -r
18144 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18145 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18146 expresson.
18147 @end table
18148
18149 @subsubheading Result
18150
18151 The result is in the form:
18152
18153 @smallexample
18154 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18155 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18156 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18157 times="@var{times}"@}
18158 @end smallexample
18159
18160 @noindent
18161 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18162 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18163 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18164 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18165 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18166 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18167 which use the same output).
18168
18169 Note: this format is open to change.
18170 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18171
18172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18173
18174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18175 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18176
18177 @subsubheading Example
18178
18179 @smallexample
18180 (gdb)
18181 -break-insert main
18182 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18183 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18184 (gdb)
18185 -break-insert -t foo
18186 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18187 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18188 (gdb)
18189 -break-list
18190 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18191 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18192 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18193 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18194 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18195 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18196 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18197 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18198 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18199 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18200 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18201 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18202 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18203 (gdb)
18204 -break-insert -r foo.*
18205 ~int foo(int, int);
18206 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18207 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18208 (gdb)
18209 @end smallexample
18210
18211 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18212 @findex -break-list
18213
18214 @subsubheading Synopsis
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 -break-list
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18221
18222 @table @samp
18223 @item Number
18224 number of the breakpoint
18225 @item Type
18226 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18227 @item Disposition
18228 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18229 or @samp{nokeep}
18230 @item Enabled
18231 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18232 @item Address
18233 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18234 @item What
18235 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18236 name, line number
18237 @item Times
18238 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18239 @end table
18240
18241 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18242 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18243
18244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18245
18246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18247
18248 @subsubheading Example
18249
18250 @smallexample
18251 (gdb)
18252 -break-list
18253 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18254 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18255 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18256 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18257 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18258 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18259 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18260 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18261 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18262 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18263 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18264 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18265 (gdb)
18266 @end smallexample
18267
18268 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18269
18270 @smallexample
18271 (gdb)
18272 -break-list
18273 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18274 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18275 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18276 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18277 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18278 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18279 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18280 body=[]@}
18281 (gdb)
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18285 @findex -break-watch
18286
18287 @subsubheading Synopsis
18288
18289 @smallexample
18290 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18291 @end smallexample
18292
18293 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18294 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18295 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18296 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18297 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18298 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18299 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18300 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18301
18302 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18303 breakpoints inserted.
18304
18305 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18306
18307 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18308 @samp{rwatch}.
18309
18310 @subsubheading Example
18311
18312 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18313
18314 @smallexample
18315 (gdb)
18316 -break-watch x
18317 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18318 (gdb)
18319 -exec-continue
18320 ^running
18321 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18322 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18323 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18324 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18325 (gdb)
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18329 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18330 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18331
18332 @smallexample
18333 (gdb)
18334 -break-watch C
18335 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18336 (gdb)
18337 -exec-continue
18338 ^running
18339 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18340 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18341 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18342 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18343 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18344 (gdb)
18345 -exec-continue
18346 ^running
18347 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18348 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18349 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18350 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18351 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18352 (gdb)
18353 @end smallexample
18354
18355 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18356 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18357 deleted.
18358
18359 @smallexample
18360 (gdb)
18361 -break-watch C
18362 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18363 (gdb)
18364 -break-list
18365 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18366 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18367 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18368 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18369 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18370 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18371 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18372 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18373 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18374 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18375 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18376 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18377 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18378 (gdb)
18379 -exec-continue
18380 ^running
18381 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18382 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18383 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18384 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18385 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18386 (gdb)
18387 -break-list
18388 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18389 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18390 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18391 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18392 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18393 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18394 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18395 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18396 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18397 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18398 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18399 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18400 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18401 (gdb)
18402 -exec-continue
18403 ^running
18404 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18405 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18406 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18407 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18408 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18409 (gdb)
18410 -break-list
18411 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18412 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18413 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18414 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18415 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18416 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18417 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18418 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18419 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18420 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18421 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18422 times="1"@}]@}
18423 (gdb)
18424 @end smallexample
18425
18426 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18427 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18428 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18429
18430 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18431 @findex -exec-arguments
18432
18433
18434 @subsubheading Synopsis
18435
18436 @smallexample
18437 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18438 @end smallexample
18439
18440 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18441 @samp{-exec-run}.
18442
18443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18444
18445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18446
18447 @subsubheading Example
18448
18449 @c FIXME!
18450 Don't have one around.
18451
18452
18453 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18454 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18455
18456 @subsubheading Synopsis
18457
18458 @smallexample
18459 -exec-show-arguments
18460 @end smallexample
18461
18462 Print the arguments of the program.
18463
18464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18465
18466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18467
18468 @subsubheading Example
18469 N.A.
18470
18471
18472 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18473 @findex -environment-cd
18474
18475 @subsubheading Synopsis
18476
18477 @smallexample
18478 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18479 @end smallexample
18480
18481 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18482
18483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18484
18485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18486
18487 @subsubheading Example
18488
18489 @smallexample
18490 (gdb)
18491 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18492 ^done
18493 (gdb)
18494 @end smallexample
18495
18496
18497 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18498 @findex -environment-directory
18499
18500 @subsubheading Synopsis
18501
18502 @smallexample
18503 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18504 @end smallexample
18505
18506 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18507 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18508 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18509 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18510 occurs as normal.
18511 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18512 multiple directories in a single command
18513 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18514 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18515 If blanks are needed as
18516 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18517 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18518 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18519 character must not be used
18520 in any directory name.
18521 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18522
18523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18524
18525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18526
18527 @subsubheading Example
18528
18529 @smallexample
18530 (gdb)
18531 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18532 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18533 (gdb)
18534 -environment-directory ""
18535 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18536 (gdb)
18537 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18538 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18539 (gdb)
18540 -environment-directory -r
18541 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18542 (gdb)
18543 @end smallexample
18544
18545
18546 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18547 @findex -environment-path
18548
18549 @subsubheading Synopsis
18550
18551 @smallexample
18552 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18553 @end smallexample
18554
18555 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18556 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18557 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18558 supplied in addition to the
18559 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18560 occurs as normal.
18561 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18562 multiple directories in a single command
18563 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18564 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18565 If blanks are needed as
18566 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18567 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18568 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18569 character must not be used
18570 in any directory name.
18571 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18572
18573
18574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18575
18576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18577
18578 @subsubheading Example
18579
18580 @smallexample
18581 (gdb)
18582 -environment-path
18583 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18584 (gdb)
18585 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18586 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18587 (gdb)
18588 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18589 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18590 (gdb)
18591 @end smallexample
18592
18593
18594 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18595 @findex -environment-pwd
18596
18597 @subsubheading Synopsis
18598
18599 @smallexample
18600 -environment-pwd
18601 @end smallexample
18602
18603 Show the current working directory.
18604
18605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18606
18607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18608
18609 @subsubheading Example
18610
18611 @smallexample
18612 (gdb)
18613 -environment-pwd
18614 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18615 (gdb)
18616 @end smallexample
18617
18618 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18619 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18620 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18621
18622
18623 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18624 @findex -thread-info
18625
18626 @subsubheading Synopsis
18627
18628 @smallexample
18629 -thread-info
18630 @end smallexample
18631
18632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18633
18634 No equivalent.
18635
18636 @subsubheading Example
18637 N.A.
18638
18639
18640 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18641 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18642
18643 @subsubheading Synopsis
18644
18645 @smallexample
18646 -thread-list-all-threads
18647 @end smallexample
18648
18649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18650
18651 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18652
18653 @subsubheading Example
18654 N.A.
18655
18656
18657 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18658 @findex -thread-list-ids
18659
18660 @subsubheading Synopsis
18661
18662 @smallexample
18663 -thread-list-ids
18664 @end smallexample
18665
18666 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18667 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18668
18669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18670
18671 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18672
18673 @subsubheading Example
18674
18675 No threads present, besides the main process:
18676
18677 @smallexample
18678 (gdb)
18679 -thread-list-ids
18680 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18681 (gdb)
18682 @end smallexample
18683
18684
18685 Several threads:
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 (gdb)
18689 -thread-list-ids
18690 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18691 number-of-threads="3"
18692 (gdb)
18693 @end smallexample
18694
18695
18696 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18697 @findex -thread-select
18698
18699 @subsubheading Synopsis
18700
18701 @smallexample
18702 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18703 @end smallexample
18704
18705 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18706 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18707
18708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18709
18710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18711
18712 @subsubheading Example
18713
18714 @smallexample
18715 (gdb)
18716 -exec-next
18717 ^running
18718 (gdb)
18719 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18720 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18721 (gdb)
18722 -thread-list-ids
18723 ^done,
18724 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18725 number-of-threads="3"
18726 (gdb)
18727 -thread-select 3
18728 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18729 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18730 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18731 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18732 (gdb)
18733 @end smallexample
18734
18735 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18736 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18737 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18738
18739 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18740 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18741 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18742 other cases.
18743
18744 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18745 @findex -exec-continue
18746
18747 @subsubheading Synopsis
18748
18749 @smallexample
18750 -exec-continue
18751 @end smallexample
18752
18753 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18754 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18755
18756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18757
18758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18759
18760 @subsubheading Example
18761
18762 @smallexample
18763 -exec-continue
18764 ^running
18765 (gdb)
18766 @@Hello world
18767 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18768 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18769 (gdb)
18770 @end smallexample
18771
18772
18773 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18774 @findex -exec-finish
18775
18776 @subsubheading Synopsis
18777
18778 @smallexample
18779 -exec-finish
18780 @end smallexample
18781
18782 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18783 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18784
18785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18786
18787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18788
18789 @subsubheading Example
18790
18791 Function returning @code{void}.
18792
18793 @smallexample
18794 -exec-finish
18795 ^running
18796 (gdb)
18797 @@hello from foo
18798 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18799 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18800 (gdb)
18801 @end smallexample
18802
18803 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18804 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18805 value itself.
18806
18807 @smallexample
18808 -exec-finish
18809 ^running
18810 (gdb)
18811 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18812 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18813 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18814 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18815 (gdb)
18816 @end smallexample
18817
18818
18819 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18820 @findex -exec-interrupt
18821
18822 @subsubheading Synopsis
18823
18824 @smallexample
18825 -exec-interrupt
18826 @end smallexample
18827
18828 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18829 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18830 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18831 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18832 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18833
18834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18835
18836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18837
18838 @subsubheading Example
18839
18840 @smallexample
18841 (gdb)
18842 111-exec-continue
18843 111^running
18844
18845 (gdb)
18846 222-exec-interrupt
18847 222^done
18848 (gdb)
18849 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18850 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18851 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18852 (gdb)
18853
18854 (gdb)
18855 -exec-interrupt
18856 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18857 (gdb)
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860
18861 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18862 @findex -exec-next
18863
18864 @subsubheading Synopsis
18865
18866 @smallexample
18867 -exec-next
18868 @end smallexample
18869
18870 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18871 of the next source line is reached.
18872
18873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18874
18875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18876
18877 @subsubheading Example
18878
18879 @smallexample
18880 -exec-next
18881 ^running
18882 (gdb)
18883 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18884 (gdb)
18885 @end smallexample
18886
18887
18888 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18889 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18890
18891 @subsubheading Synopsis
18892
18893 @smallexample
18894 -exec-next-instruction
18895 @end smallexample
18896
18897 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18898 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18899 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18900 printed as well.
18901
18902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18903
18904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18905
18906 @subsubheading Example
18907
18908 @smallexample
18909 (gdb)
18910 -exec-next-instruction
18911 ^running
18912
18913 (gdb)
18914 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18915 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18916 (gdb)
18917 @end smallexample
18918
18919
18920 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18921 @findex -exec-return
18922
18923 @subsubheading Synopsis
18924
18925 @smallexample
18926 -exec-return
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18930 Displays the new current frame.
18931
18932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18933
18934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18935
18936 @subsubheading Example
18937
18938 @smallexample
18939 (gdb)
18940 200-break-insert callee4
18941 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18942 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18943 (gdb)
18944 000-exec-run
18945 000^running
18946 (gdb)
18947 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18948 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18949 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18950 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18951 (gdb)
18952 205-break-delete
18953 205^done
18954 (gdb)
18955 111-exec-return
18956 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18957 args=[@{name="strarg",
18958 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18959 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18960 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18961 (gdb)
18962 @end smallexample
18963
18964
18965 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18966 @findex -exec-run
18967
18968 @subsubheading Synopsis
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 -exec-run
18972 @end smallexample
18973
18974 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18975 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18976 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18977 the program has exited exceptionally.
18978
18979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18980
18981 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18982
18983 @subsubheading Examples
18984
18985 @smallexample
18986 (gdb)
18987 -break-insert main
18988 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18989 (gdb)
18990 -exec-run
18991 ^running
18992 (gdb)
18993 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18994 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18996 (gdb)
18997 @end smallexample
18998
18999 @noindent
19000 Program exited normally:
19001
19002 @smallexample
19003 (gdb)
19004 -exec-run
19005 ^running
19006 (gdb)
19007 x = 55
19008 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19009 (gdb)
19010 @end smallexample
19011
19012 @noindent
19013 Program exited exceptionally:
19014
19015 @smallexample
19016 (gdb)
19017 -exec-run
19018 ^running
19019 (gdb)
19020 x = 55
19021 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19022 (gdb)
19023 @end smallexample
19024
19025 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19026 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19027
19028 @smallexample
19029 (gdb)
19030 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19031 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19032 @end smallexample
19033
19034
19035 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19036
19037
19038 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19039 @findex -exec-step
19040
19041 @subsubheading Synopsis
19042
19043 @smallexample
19044 -exec-step
19045 @end smallexample
19046
19047 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19048 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19049 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19050 function.
19051
19052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19053
19054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19055
19056 @subsubheading Example
19057
19058 Stepping into a function:
19059
19060 @smallexample
19061 -exec-step
19062 ^running
19063 (gdb)
19064 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19065 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19066 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19067 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19068 (gdb)
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071 Regular stepping:
19072
19073 @smallexample
19074 -exec-step
19075 ^running
19076 (gdb)
19077 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19078 (gdb)
19079 @end smallexample
19080
19081
19082 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19083 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19084
19085 @subsubheading Synopsis
19086
19087 @smallexample
19088 -exec-step-instruction
19089 @end smallexample
19090
19091 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19092 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19093 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19094 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19095 well.
19096
19097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19098
19099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19100
19101 @subsubheading Example
19102
19103 @smallexample
19104 (gdb)
19105 -exec-step-instruction
19106 ^running
19107
19108 (gdb)
19109 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19110 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19111 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19112 (gdb)
19113 -exec-step-instruction
19114 ^running
19115
19116 (gdb)
19117 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19118 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19119 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19120 (gdb)
19121 @end smallexample
19122
19123
19124 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19125 @findex -exec-until
19126
19127 @subsubheading Synopsis
19128
19129 @smallexample
19130 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19131 @end smallexample
19132
19133 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19134 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19135 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19136 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19137
19138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19139
19140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19141
19142 @subsubheading Example
19143
19144 @smallexample
19145 (gdb)
19146 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19147 ^running
19148 (gdb)
19149 x = 55
19150 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19151 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19152 (gdb)
19153 @end smallexample
19154
19155 @ignore
19156 @subheading -file-clear
19157 Is this going away????
19158 @end ignore
19159
19160 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19161 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19162 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19163
19164
19165 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19166 @findex -stack-info-frame
19167
19168 @subsubheading Synopsis
19169
19170 @smallexample
19171 -stack-info-frame
19172 @end smallexample
19173
19174 Get info on the selected frame.
19175
19176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19177
19178 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19179 (without arguments).
19180
19181 @subsubheading Example
19182
19183 @smallexample
19184 (gdb)
19185 -stack-info-frame
19186 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19187 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19188 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19189 (gdb)
19190 @end smallexample
19191
19192 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19193 @findex -stack-info-depth
19194
19195 @subsubheading Synopsis
19196
19197 @smallexample
19198 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19199 @end smallexample
19200
19201 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19202 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19203
19204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19205
19206 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19207
19208 @subsubheading Example
19209
19210 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19211
19212 @smallexample
19213 (gdb)
19214 -stack-info-depth
19215 ^done,depth="12"
19216 (gdb)
19217 -stack-info-depth 4
19218 ^done,depth="4"
19219 (gdb)
19220 -stack-info-depth 12
19221 ^done,depth="12"
19222 (gdb)
19223 -stack-info-depth 11
19224 ^done,depth="11"
19225 (gdb)
19226 -stack-info-depth 13
19227 ^done,depth="12"
19228 (gdb)
19229 @end smallexample
19230
19231 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19232 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19233
19234 @subsubheading Synopsis
19235
19236 @smallexample
19237 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19238 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19239 @end smallexample
19240
19241 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19242 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19243 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19244 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19245 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19246 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19247 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19248 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19249
19250 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19251 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19252 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19253
19254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19255
19256 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19257 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19258 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19259
19260 @subsubheading Example
19261
19262 @smallexample
19263 (gdb)
19264 -stack-list-frames
19265 ^done,
19266 stack=[
19267 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19268 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19269 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19270 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19271 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19272 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19273 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19274 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19275 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19276 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19279 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19280 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19281 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19282 (gdb)
19283 -stack-list-arguments 0
19284 ^done,
19285 stack-args=[
19286 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19287 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19288 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19289 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19290 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19291 (gdb)
19292 -stack-list-arguments 1
19293 ^done,
19294 stack-args=[
19295 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19296 frame=@{level="1",
19297 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19298 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19299 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19300 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19301 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19302 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19303 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19304 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19305 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19306 (gdb)
19307 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19308 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19309 (gdb)
19310 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19311 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19312 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19313 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19314 (gdb)
19315 @end smallexample
19316
19317 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19318
19319
19320 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19321 @findex -stack-list-frames
19322
19323 @subsubheading Synopsis
19324
19325 @smallexample
19326 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19327 @end smallexample
19328
19329 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19330 following info:
19331
19332 @table @samp
19333 @item @var{level}
19334 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19335 @item @var{addr}
19336 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19337 @item @var{func}
19338 Function name.
19339 @item @var{file}
19340 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19341 @item @var{line}
19342 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19343 @end table
19344
19345 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19346 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19347 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19348 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19349 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19350 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19351 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19352
19353 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19354
19355 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19356
19357 @subsubheading Example
19358
19359 Full stack backtrace:
19360
19361 @smallexample
19362 (gdb)
19363 -stack-list-frames
19364 ^done,stack=
19365 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19366 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19367 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19368 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19369 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19370 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19371 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19372 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19373 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19374 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19375 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19376 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19377 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19378 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19379 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19380 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19381 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19382 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19383 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19384 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19385 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19386 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19387 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19388 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19389 (gdb)
19390 @end smallexample
19391
19392 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19393
19394 @smallexample
19395 (gdb)
19396 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19397 ^done,stack=
19398 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19400 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19401 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19402 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19403 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19404 (gdb)
19405 @end smallexample
19406
19407 Show a single frame:
19408
19409 @smallexample
19410 (gdb)
19411 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19412 ^done,stack=
19413 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19414 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19415 (gdb)
19416 @end smallexample
19417
19418
19419 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19420 @findex -stack-list-locals
19421
19422 @subsubheading Synopsis
19423
19424 @smallexample
19425 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19426 @end smallexample
19427
19428 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19429 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19430 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19431 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19432 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19433 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19434 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19435 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19436 more detail.
19437
19438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19439
19440 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19441
19442 @subsubheading Example
19443
19444 @smallexample
19445 (gdb)
19446 -stack-list-locals 0
19447 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19448 (gdb)
19449 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19450 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19451 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19452 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19453 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19454 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19455 (gdb)
19456 @end smallexample
19457
19458
19459 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19460 @findex -stack-select-frame
19461
19462 @subsubheading Synopsis
19463
19464 @smallexample
19465 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19466 @end smallexample
19467
19468 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19469 the stack.
19470
19471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19472
19473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19474 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19475
19476 @subsubheading Example
19477
19478 @smallexample
19479 (gdb)
19480 -stack-select-frame 2
19481 ^done
19482 (gdb)
19483 @end smallexample
19484
19485 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19486 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19487 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19488
19489
19490 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19491
19492 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19493 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19494 used by @code{Insight}.
19495
19496 The two main reasons for that are:
19497
19498 @enumerate 1
19499 @item
19500 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19501
19502 @item
19503 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19504 now).
19505 @end enumerate
19506
19507 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19508 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19509 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19510 hints about their use.
19511
19512 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19513 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19514 least, the following operations:
19515
19516 @itemize @bullet
19517 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19518 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19519 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19520 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19521 @end itemize
19522
19523 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19524
19525 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19526 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19527 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19528 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19529 examining or changing its properties.
19530
19531 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19532 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19533 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19534 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19535 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19536
19537 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19538 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19539 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19540 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19541 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19542 for pointers, etc.).
19543
19544 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19545 access this functionality:
19546
19547 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19548 @item @strong{Operation}
19549 @tab @strong{Description}
19550
19551 @item @code{-var-create}
19552 @tab create a variable object
19553 @item @code{-var-delete}
19554 @tab delete the variable object and its children
19555 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19556 @tab set the display format of this variable
19557 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19558 @tab show the display format of this variable
19559 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19560 @tab tells how many children this object has
19561 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19562 @tab return a list of the object's children
19563 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19564 @tab show the type of this variable object
19565 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19566 @tab print what this variable object represents
19567 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19568 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19569 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19570 @tab get the value of this variable
19571 @item @code{-var-assign}
19572 @tab set the value of this variable
19573 @item @code{-var-update}
19574 @tab update the variable and its children
19575 @end multitable
19576
19577 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19578 how it can be used.
19579
19580 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19581
19582 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19583 @findex -var-create
19584
19585 @subsubheading Synopsis
19586
19587 @smallexample
19588 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19589 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19590 @end smallexample
19591
19592 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19593 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19594 register.
19595
19596 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19597 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19598 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19599 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19600 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19601
19602 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19603 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19604 frame should be used.
19605
19606 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19607 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19608
19609 @itemize @bullet
19610 @item
19611 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19612
19613 @item
19614 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19615
19616 @item
19617 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19618 @end itemize
19619
19620 @subsubheading Result
19621
19622 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19623 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19624 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19625
19626 @smallexample
19627 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19628 @end smallexample
19629
19630
19631 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19632 @findex -var-delete
19633
19634 @subsubheading Synopsis
19635
19636 @smallexample
19637 -var-delete @var{name}
19638 @end smallexample
19639
19640 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19641
19642 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19643
19644
19645 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19646 @findex -var-set-format
19647
19648 @subsubheading Synopsis
19649
19650 @smallexample
19651 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19652 @end smallexample
19653
19654 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19655 @var{format-spec}.
19656
19657 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19658
19659 @smallexample
19660 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19661 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664
19665 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19666 @findex -var-show-format
19667
19668 @subsubheading Synopsis
19669
19670 @smallexample
19671 -var-show-format @var{name}
19672 @end smallexample
19673
19674 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19675
19676 @smallexample
19677 @var{format} @expansion{}
19678 @var{format-spec}
19679 @end smallexample
19680
19681
19682 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19683 @findex -var-info-num-children
19684
19685 @subsubheading Synopsis
19686
19687 @smallexample
19688 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 numchild=@var{n}
19695 @end smallexample
19696
19697
19698 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19699 @findex -var-list-children
19700
19701 @subsubheading Synopsis
19702
19703 @smallexample
19704 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19705 @end smallexample
19706 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19707
19708 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19709 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19710 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19711 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19712 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19713 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19714 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19715 and unions.
19716
19717 @subsubheading Example
19718
19719 @smallexample
19720 (gdb)
19721 -var-list-children n
19722 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19723 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19724 (gdb)
19725 -var-list-children --all-values n
19726 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19727 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19728 @end smallexample
19729
19730
19731 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19732 @findex -var-info-type
19733
19734 @subsubheading Synopsis
19735
19736 @smallexample
19737 -var-info-type @var{name}
19738 @end smallexample
19739
19740 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19741 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19742 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19743
19744 @smallexample
19745 type=@var{typename}
19746 @end smallexample
19747
19748
19749 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19750 @findex -var-info-expression
19751
19752 @subsubheading Synopsis
19753
19754 @smallexample
19755 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19756 @end smallexample
19757
19758 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19759
19760 @smallexample
19761 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19762 @end smallexample
19763
19764 @noindent
19765 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19766
19767 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19768 @findex -var-show-attributes
19769
19770 @subsubheading Synopsis
19771
19772 @smallexample
19773 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19774 @end smallexample
19775
19776 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19777
19778 @smallexample
19779 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19780 @end smallexample
19781
19782 @noindent
19783 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19784
19785 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19786 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19787
19788 @subsubheading Synopsis
19789
19790 @smallexample
19791 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19795 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19796 for the object:
19797
19798 @smallexample
19799 value=@var{value}
19800 @end smallexample
19801
19802 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19803 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19804
19805 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19806 @findex -var-assign
19807
19808 @subsubheading Synopsis
19809
19810 @smallexample
19811 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19812 @end smallexample
19813
19814 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19815 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19816 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19817 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19818
19819 @subsubheading Example
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 (gdb)
19823 -var-assign var1 3
19824 ^done,value="3"
19825 (gdb)
19826 -var-update *
19827 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19828 (gdb)
19829 @end smallexample
19830
19831 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19832 @findex -var-update
19833
19834 @subsubheading Synopsis
19835
19836 @smallexample
19837 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19838 @end smallexample
19839
19840 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19841 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19842 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19843 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19844 just names are printed in the manner described for
19845 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19846
19847 @subsubheading Example
19848
19849 @smallexample
19850 (gdb)
19851 -var-assign var1 3
19852 ^done,value="3"
19853 (gdb)
19854 -var-update --all-values var1
19855 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19856 type_changed="false"@}]
19857 (gdb)
19858 @end smallexample
19859
19860 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19861 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19862 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19863
19864 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19865 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19866 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19867 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19868
19869 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19870 @c @subheading -data-assign
19871 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19872 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19873 @c set variable
19874 @c @subsubheading Example
19875 @c N.A.
19876
19877 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19878 @findex -data-disassemble
19879
19880 @subsubheading Synopsis
19881
19882 @smallexample
19883 -data-disassemble
19884 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19885 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19886 -- @var{mode}
19887 @end smallexample
19888
19889 @noindent
19890 Where:
19891
19892 @table @samp
19893 @item @var{start-addr}
19894 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19895 @item @var{end-addr}
19896 is the end address
19897 @item @var{filename}
19898 is the name of the file to disassemble
19899 @item @var{linenum}
19900 is the line number to disassemble around
19901 @item @var{lines}
19902 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19903 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19904 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19905 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19906 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19907 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19908 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19909 are displayed.
19910 @item @var{mode}
19911 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19912 disassembly).
19913 @end table
19914
19915 @subsubheading Result
19916
19917 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19918
19919 @itemize @bullet
19920 @item Address
19921 @item Func-name
19922 @item Offset
19923 @item Instruction
19924 @end itemize
19925
19926 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19927 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19928
19929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19930
19931 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19932
19933 @subsubheading Example
19934
19935 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19936
19937 @smallexample
19938 (gdb)
19939 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19940 ^done,
19941 asm_insns=[
19942 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19943 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19944 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19945 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19946 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19947 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19948 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19949 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19950 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19951 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19952 (gdb)
19953 @end smallexample
19954
19955 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19956 @code{main}.
19957
19958 @smallexample
19959 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19960 ^done,asm_insns=[
19961 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19962 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19963 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19964 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19965 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19966 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19967 [@dots{}]
19968 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19969 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19970 (gdb)
19971 @end smallexample
19972
19973 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19974
19975 @smallexample
19976 (gdb)
19977 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19978 ^done,asm_insns=[
19979 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19980 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19981 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19982 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19983 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19984 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19985 (gdb)
19986 @end smallexample
19987
19988 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19989
19990 @smallexample
19991 (gdb)
19992 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19993 ^done,asm_insns=[
19994 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19995 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19996 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19997 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19998 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19999 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20000 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20001 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20002 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20003 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20004 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20005 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20006 (gdb)
20007 @end smallexample
20008
20009
20010 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20011 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20012
20013 @subsubheading Synopsis
20014
20015 @smallexample
20016 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20017 @end smallexample
20018
20019 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20020 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20021 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20022
20023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20024
20025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20026 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20027 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20028
20029 @subsubheading Example
20030
20031 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20032 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20033 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20034 output.
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20038 211^done,value="1"
20039 (gdb)
20040 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20041 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20042 (gdb)
20043 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20044 411^done,value="4"
20045 (gdb)
20046 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20047 511^done,value="4"
20048 (gdb)
20049 @end smallexample
20050
20051
20052 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20053 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20054
20055 @subsubheading Synopsis
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 -data-list-changed-registers
20059 @end smallexample
20060
20061 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20062
20063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20064
20065 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20066 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20067
20068 @subsubheading Example
20069
20070 On a PPC MBX board:
20071
20072 @smallexample
20073 (gdb)
20074 -exec-continue
20075 ^running
20076
20077 (gdb)
20078 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20079 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20080 (gdb)
20081 -data-list-changed-registers
20082 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20083 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20084 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20085 (gdb)
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088
20089 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20090 @findex -data-list-register-names
20091
20092 @subsubheading Synopsis
20093
20094 @smallexample
20095 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20096 @end smallexample
20097
20098 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20099 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20100 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20101 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20102 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20103 include empty register names.
20104
20105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20106
20107 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20108 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20109 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20110
20111 @subsubheading Example
20112
20113 For the PPC MBX board:
20114 @smallexample
20115 (gdb)
20116 -data-list-register-names
20117 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20118 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20119 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20120 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20121 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20122 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20123 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20124 (gdb)
20125 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20126 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20127 (gdb)
20128 @end smallexample
20129
20130 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20131 @findex -data-list-register-values
20132
20133 @subsubheading Synopsis
20134
20135 @smallexample
20136 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20137 @end smallexample
20138
20139 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20140 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20141 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20142 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20143
20144 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20145
20146 @table @code
20147 @item x
20148 Hexadecimal
20149 @item o
20150 Octal
20151 @item t
20152 Binary
20153 @item d
20154 Decimal
20155 @item r
20156 Raw
20157 @item N
20158 Natural
20159 @end table
20160
20161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20162
20163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20164 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20165
20166 @subsubheading Example
20167
20168 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20169 don't appear in the actual output):
20170
20171 @smallexample
20172 (gdb)
20173 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20174 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20175 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20176 (gdb)
20177 -data-list-register-values x
20178 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20179 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20180 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20181 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20182 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20183 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20184 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20185 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20186 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20187 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20188 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20189 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20190 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20191 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20192 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20193 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20194 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20195 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20196 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20197 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20198 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20199 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20200 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20201 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20202 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20203 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20204 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20205 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20206 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20207 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20208 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20209 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20210 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20211 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20212 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20213 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20214 (gdb)
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217
20218 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20219 @findex -data-read-memory
20220
20221 @subsubheading Synopsis
20222
20223 @smallexample
20224 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20225 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20226 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20227 @end smallexample
20228
20229 @noindent
20230 where:
20231
20232 @table @samp
20233 @item @var{address}
20234 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20235 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20236 quoted using the C convention.
20237
20238 @item @var{word-format}
20239 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20240 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20241 ,Output formats}).
20242
20243 @item @var{word-size}
20244 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20245
20246 @item @var{nr-rows}
20247 The number of rows in the output table.
20248
20249 @item @var{nr-cols}
20250 The number of columns in the output table.
20251
20252 @item @var{aschar}
20253 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20254 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20255 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20256 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20257
20258 @item @var{byte-offset}
20259 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20260 @end table
20261
20262 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20263 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20264 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20265 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20266 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20267 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20268 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20269 @samp{addr}.
20270
20271 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20272 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20273 @samp{prev-page}.
20274
20275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20276
20277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20278 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20279
20280 @subsubheading Example
20281
20282 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20283 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20284 word. Display each word in hex.
20285
20286 @smallexample
20287 (gdb)
20288 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20289 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20290 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20291 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20292 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20293 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20294 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20295 (gdb)
20296 @end smallexample
20297
20298 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20299 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20300
20301 @smallexample
20302 (gdb)
20303 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20304 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20305 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20306 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20307 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20308 (gdb)
20309 @end smallexample
20310
20311 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20312 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20313 used as the non-printable character.
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 (gdb)
20317 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20318 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20319 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20320 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20321 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20322 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20323 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20324 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20325 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20326 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20327 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20328 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20329 (gdb)
20330 @end smallexample
20331
20332 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20333 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20334 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20335
20336 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20337
20338 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20339
20340 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20341
20342 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20343
20344 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20345
20346 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20347
20348 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20349
20350 @c @subheading -trace-find
20351
20352 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20353
20354 @c @subheading -trace-info
20355
20356 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20357
20358 @c @subheading -trace-list
20359
20360 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20361
20362 @c @subheading -trace-save
20363
20364 @c @subheading -trace-start
20365
20366 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20367
20368
20369 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20370 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20371 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20372
20373
20374 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20375 @findex -symbol-info-address
20376
20377 @subsubheading Synopsis
20378
20379 @smallexample
20380 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20381 @end smallexample
20382
20383 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20384
20385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20386
20387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20388
20389 @subsubheading Example
20390 N.A.
20391
20392
20393 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20394 @findex -symbol-info-file
20395
20396 @subsubheading Synopsis
20397
20398 @smallexample
20399 -symbol-info-file
20400 @end smallexample
20401
20402 Show the file for the symbol.
20403
20404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20405
20406 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20407 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20408
20409 @subsubheading Example
20410 N.A.
20411
20412
20413 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20414 @findex -symbol-info-function
20415
20416 @subsubheading Synopsis
20417
20418 @smallexample
20419 -symbol-info-function
20420 @end smallexample
20421
20422 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20423
20424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20425
20426 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20427
20428 @subsubheading Example
20429 N.A.
20430
20431
20432 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20433 @findex -symbol-info-line
20434
20435 @subsubheading Synopsis
20436
20437 @smallexample
20438 -symbol-info-line
20439 @end smallexample
20440
20441 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20442
20443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20444
20445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20446 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20447
20448 @subsubheading Example
20449 N.A.
20450
20451
20452 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20453 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20454
20455 @subsubheading Synopsis
20456
20457 @smallexample
20458 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20459 @end smallexample
20460
20461 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20462
20463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20464
20465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20466
20467 @subsubheading Example
20468 N.A.
20469
20470
20471 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20472 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20473
20474 @subsubheading Synopsis
20475
20476 @smallexample
20477 -symbol-list-functions
20478 @end smallexample
20479
20480 List the functions in the executable.
20481
20482 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20483
20484 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20485 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20486
20487 @subsubheading Example
20488 N.A.
20489
20490
20491 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20492 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20493
20494 @subsubheading Synopsis
20495
20496 @smallexample
20497 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20498 @end smallexample
20499
20500 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20501 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20502 ascending PC order.
20503
20504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20505
20506 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20507
20508 @subsubheading Example
20509 @smallexample
20510 (gdb)
20511 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20512 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20513 (gdb)
20514 @end smallexample
20515
20516
20517 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20518 @findex -symbol-list-types
20519
20520 @subsubheading Synopsis
20521
20522 @smallexample
20523 -symbol-list-types
20524 @end smallexample
20525
20526 List all the type names.
20527
20528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20529
20530 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20531 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20532
20533 @subsubheading Example
20534 N.A.
20535
20536
20537 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20538 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20539
20540 @subsubheading Synopsis
20541
20542 @smallexample
20543 -symbol-list-variables
20544 @end smallexample
20545
20546 List all the global and static variable names.
20547
20548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20549
20550 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20551
20552 @subsubheading Example
20553 N.A.
20554
20555
20556 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20557 @findex -symbol-locate
20558
20559 @subsubheading Synopsis
20560
20561 @smallexample
20562 -symbol-locate
20563 @end smallexample
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20568
20569 @subsubheading Example
20570 N.A.
20571
20572
20573 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20574 @findex -symbol-type
20575
20576 @subsubheading Synopsis
20577
20578 @smallexample
20579 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20580 @end smallexample
20581
20582 Show type of @var{variable}.
20583
20584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20585
20586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20587 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20588
20589 @subsubheading Example
20590 N.A.
20591
20592
20593 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20594 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20595 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20596
20597 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20598 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20599
20600 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20601 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20602
20603 @subsubheading Synopsis
20604
20605 @smallexample
20606 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20607 @end smallexample
20608
20609 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20610 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20611 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20612 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20613 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20614 notification.
20615
20616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20617
20618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20619
20620 @subsubheading Example
20621
20622 @smallexample
20623 (gdb)
20624 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20625 ^done
20626 (gdb)
20627 @end smallexample
20628
20629
20630 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20631 @findex -file-exec-file
20632
20633 @subsubheading Synopsis
20634
20635 @smallexample
20636 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20637 @end smallexample
20638
20639 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20640 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20641 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20642 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20643 notification.
20644
20645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20646
20647 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20648
20649 @subsubheading Example
20650
20651 @smallexample
20652 (gdb)
20653 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20654 ^done
20655 (gdb)
20656 @end smallexample
20657
20658
20659 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20660 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20661
20662 @subsubheading Synopsis
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 -file-list-exec-sections
20666 @end smallexample
20667
20668 List the sections of the current executable file.
20669
20670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20671
20672 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20673 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20674 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20675
20676 @subsubheading Example
20677 N.A.
20678
20679
20680 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20681 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20682
20683 @subsubheading Synopsis
20684
20685 @smallexample
20686 -file-list-exec-source-file
20687 @end smallexample
20688
20689 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20690 to the current source file for the current executable.
20691
20692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20693
20694 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20695
20696 @subsubheading Example
20697
20698 @smallexample
20699 (gdb)
20700 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20701 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20702 (gdb)
20703 @end smallexample
20704
20705
20706 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20707 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20708
20709 @subsubheading Synopsis
20710
20711 @smallexample
20712 -file-list-exec-source-files
20713 @end smallexample
20714
20715 List the source files for the current executable.
20716
20717 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20718 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20719
20720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20721
20722 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20723 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20724
20725 @subsubheading Example
20726 @smallexample
20727 (gdb)
20728 -file-list-exec-source-files
20729 ^done,files=[
20730 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20731 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20732 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20733 (gdb)
20734 @end smallexample
20735
20736 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20737 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20738
20739 @subsubheading Synopsis
20740
20741 @smallexample
20742 -file-list-shared-libraries
20743 @end smallexample
20744
20745 List the shared libraries in the program.
20746
20747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20748
20749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20750
20751 @subsubheading Example
20752 N.A.
20753
20754
20755 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20756 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20757
20758 @subsubheading Synopsis
20759
20760 @smallexample
20761 -file-list-symbol-files
20762 @end smallexample
20763
20764 List symbol files.
20765
20766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20767
20768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20769
20770 @subsubheading Example
20771 N.A.
20772
20773
20774 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20775 @findex -file-symbol-file
20776
20777 @subsubheading Synopsis
20778
20779 @smallexample
20780 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20781 @end smallexample
20782
20783 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20784 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20785 produced, except for a completion notification.
20786
20787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20788
20789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20790
20791 @subsubheading Example
20792
20793 @smallexample
20794 (gdb)
20795 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20796 ^done
20797 (gdb)
20798 @end smallexample
20799
20800 @ignore
20801 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20802 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20803 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20804
20805 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20806
20807 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20808
20809 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20810
20811 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20812
20813 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20814
20815 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20816
20817 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20818
20819 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20820
20821 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20822 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20823 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20824
20825 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20826
20827 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20828
20829 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20830
20831 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20832 @end ignore
20833
20834
20835 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20836 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20837 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20838
20839
20840 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20841 @findex -target-attach
20842
20843 @subsubheading Synopsis
20844
20845 @smallexample
20846 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20847 @end smallexample
20848
20849 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20850
20851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20852
20853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20854
20855 @subsubheading Example
20856 N.A.
20857
20858
20859 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20860 @findex -target-compare-sections
20861
20862 @subsubheading Synopsis
20863
20864 @smallexample
20865 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20866 @end smallexample
20867
20868 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20869 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20870
20871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20872
20873 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20874
20875 @subsubheading Example
20876 N.A.
20877
20878
20879 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20880 @findex -target-detach
20881
20882 @subsubheading Synopsis
20883
20884 @smallexample
20885 -target-detach
20886 @end smallexample
20887
20888 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20889 There's no output.
20890
20891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20892
20893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20894
20895 @subsubheading Example
20896
20897 @smallexample
20898 (gdb)
20899 -target-detach
20900 ^done
20901 (gdb)
20902 @end smallexample
20903
20904
20905 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20906 @findex -target-disconnect
20907
20908 @subsubheading Synopsis
20909
20910 @example
20911 -target-disconnect
20912 @end example
20913
20914 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20915 generally not resumed.
20916
20917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20918
20919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20920
20921 @subsubheading Example
20922
20923 @smallexample
20924 (gdb)
20925 -target-disconnect
20926 ^done
20927 (gdb)
20928 @end smallexample
20929
20930
20931 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20932 @findex -target-download
20933
20934 @subsubheading Synopsis
20935
20936 @smallexample
20937 -target-download
20938 @end smallexample
20939
20940 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20941 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20942
20943 @table @samp
20944 @item section
20945 The name of the section.
20946 @item section-sent
20947 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20948 @item section-size
20949 The size of the section.
20950 @item total-sent
20951 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20952 @item total-size
20953 The size of the overall executable to download.
20954 @end table
20955
20956 @noindent
20957 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20958 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20959
20960 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20961 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20962
20963 @table @samp
20964 @item section
20965 The name of the section.
20966 @item section-size
20967 The size of the section.
20968 @item total-size
20969 The size of the overall executable to download.
20970 @end table
20971
20972 @noindent
20973 At the end, a summary is printed.
20974
20975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20976
20977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20978
20979 @subsubheading Example
20980
20981 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20982 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20983
20984 @smallexample
20985 (gdb)
20986 -target-download
20987 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20988 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20989 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20990 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20991 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20992 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20993 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20994 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20995 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20996 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20997 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20998 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20999 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21000 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21001 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21002 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21003 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21004 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21005 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21006 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21007 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21008 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21009 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21010 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21011 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21012 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21013 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21014 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21015 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21016 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21017 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21018 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21019 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21020 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21021 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21022 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21023 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21024 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21025 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21026 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21027 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21028 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21029 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21030 write-rate="429"
21031 (gdb)
21032 @end smallexample
21033
21034
21035 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21036 @findex -target-exec-status
21037
21038 @subsubheading Synopsis
21039
21040 @smallexample
21041 -target-exec-status
21042 @end smallexample
21043
21044 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21045 not, for instance).
21046
21047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21048
21049 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21050
21051 @subsubheading Example
21052 N.A.
21053
21054
21055 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21056 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21057
21058 @subsubheading Synopsis
21059
21060 @smallexample
21061 -target-list-available-targets
21062 @end smallexample
21063
21064 List the possible targets to connect to.
21065
21066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21067
21068 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21069
21070 @subsubheading Example
21071 N.A.
21072
21073
21074 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21075 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21076
21077 @subsubheading Synopsis
21078
21079 @smallexample
21080 -target-list-current-targets
21081 @end smallexample
21082
21083 Describe the current target.
21084
21085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21086
21087 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21088 other things).
21089
21090 @subsubheading Example
21091 N.A.
21092
21093
21094 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21095 @findex -target-list-parameters
21096
21097 @subsubheading Synopsis
21098
21099 @smallexample
21100 -target-list-parameters
21101 @end smallexample
21102
21103 @c ????
21104
21105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21106
21107 No equivalent.
21108
21109 @subsubheading Example
21110 N.A.
21111
21112
21113 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21114 @findex -target-select
21115
21116 @subsubheading Synopsis
21117
21118 @smallexample
21119 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21120 @end smallexample
21121
21122 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21123
21124 @table @samp
21125 @item @var{type}
21126 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21127 @item @var{parameters}
21128 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21129 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21130 @end table
21131
21132 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21133 which the target program is, in the following form:
21134
21135 @smallexample
21136 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21137 args=[@var{arg list}]
21138 @end smallexample
21139
21140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21141
21142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21143
21144 @subsubheading Example
21145
21146 @smallexample
21147 (gdb)
21148 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21149 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21150 (gdb)
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21154 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21155 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21156
21157 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21158
21159 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21160 @findex -gdb-exit
21161
21162 @subsubheading Synopsis
21163
21164 @smallexample
21165 -gdb-exit
21166 @end smallexample
21167
21168 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21169
21170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21171
21172 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21173
21174 @subsubheading Example
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 (gdb)
21178 -gdb-exit
21179 ^exit
21180 @end smallexample
21181
21182
21183 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21184 @findex -exec-abort
21185
21186 @subsubheading Synopsis
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 -exec-abort
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 Kill the inferior running program.
21193
21194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21195
21196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21197
21198 @subsubheading Example
21199 N.A.
21200
21201
21202 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21203 @findex -gdb-set
21204
21205 @subsubheading Synopsis
21206
21207 @smallexample
21208 -gdb-set
21209 @end smallexample
21210
21211 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21212 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21213
21214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21215
21216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21217
21218 @subsubheading Example
21219
21220 @smallexample
21221 (gdb)
21222 -gdb-set $foo=3
21223 ^done
21224 (gdb)
21225 @end smallexample
21226
21227
21228 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21229 @findex -gdb-show
21230
21231 @subsubheading Synopsis
21232
21233 @smallexample
21234 -gdb-show
21235 @end smallexample
21236
21237 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21238
21239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21240
21241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21242
21243 @subsubheading Example
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 (gdb)
21247 -gdb-show annotate
21248 ^done,value="0"
21249 (gdb)
21250 @end smallexample
21251
21252 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21253
21254
21255 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21256 @findex -gdb-version
21257
21258 @subsubheading Synopsis
21259
21260 @smallexample
21261 -gdb-version
21262 @end smallexample
21263
21264 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21265
21266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21267
21268 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21269 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21270
21271 @subsubheading Example
21272
21273 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21274 @c box in TeX.
21275 @smallexample
21276 (gdb)
21277 -gdb-version
21278 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21279 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21280 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21281 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21282 ~ certain conditions.
21283 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21284 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21285 ~ details.
21286 ~This GDB was configured as
21287 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21288 ^done
21289 (gdb)
21290 @end smallexample
21291
21292 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21293 @findex -interpreter-exec
21294
21295 @subheading Synopsis
21296
21297 @smallexample
21298 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21299 @end smallexample
21300 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21301
21302 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21303
21304 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21305
21306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21307
21308 @subheading Example
21309
21310 @smallexample
21311 (gdb)
21312 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21313 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21314 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21315 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21316 ^done
21317 (gdb)
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21321 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21322
21323 @subheading Synopsis
21324
21325 @smallexample
21326 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21330
21331 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21332
21333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21334
21335 @subheading Example
21336
21337 @smallexample
21338 (gdb)
21339 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21340 ^done
21341 (gdb)
21342 @end smallexample
21343
21344 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21345 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21346
21347 @subheading Synopsis
21348
21349 @smallexample
21350 -inferior-tty-show
21351 @end smallexample
21352
21353 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21354
21355 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21356
21357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21358
21359 @subheading Example
21360
21361 @smallexample
21362 (gdb)
21363 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21364 ^done
21365 (gdb)
21366 -inferior-tty-show
21367 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21368 (gdb)
21369 @end smallexample
21370
21371 @node Annotations
21372 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21373
21374 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21375 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21376 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21377 relatively high level.
21378
21379 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21380 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21381
21382 @ignore
21383 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21384 @end ignore
21385
21386 @menu
21387 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21388 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21389 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21390 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21391 * Annotations for Running::
21392 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21393 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21394 @end menu
21395
21396 @node Annotations Overview
21397 @section What is an Annotation?
21398 @cindex annotations
21399
21400 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21401 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21402 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21403 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21404 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21405 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21406 cannot contain newline characters.
21407
21408 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21409 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21410 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21411 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21412 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21413 means those three characters as output.
21414
21415 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21416 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21417 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21418 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21419 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21420 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21421 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21422 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21423 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21424
21425 @table @code
21426 @kindex set annotate
21427 @item set annotate @var{level}
21428 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21429 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21430
21431 @item show annotate
21432 @kindex show annotate
21433 Show the current annotation level.
21434 @end table
21435
21436 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21437
21438 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21439
21440 @smallexample
21441 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21442 GNU gdb 6.0
21443 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21444 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21445 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21446 under certain conditions.
21447 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21448 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21449 for details.
21450 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21451
21452 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21453 (@value{GDBP})
21454 ^Z^Zprompt
21455 @kbd{quit}
21456
21457 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21458 $
21459 @end smallexample
21460
21461 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21462 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21463 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21464 output from @value{GDBN}.
21465
21466 @node Prompting
21467 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21468
21469 @cindex annotations for prompts
21470 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21471 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21472 over, etc.
21473
21474 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21475 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21476 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21477 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21478 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21479 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21480 features the following annotations:
21481
21482 @smallexample
21483 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21484 ^Z^Zprompt
21485 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 The input types are
21489
21490 @table @code
21491 @findex pre-prompt
21492 @findex prompt
21493 @findex post-prompt
21494 @item prompt
21495 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21496
21497 @findex pre-commands
21498 @findex commands
21499 @findex post-commands
21500 @item commands
21501 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21502 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21503
21504 @findex pre-overload-choice
21505 @findex overload-choice
21506 @findex post-overload-choice
21507 @item overload-choice
21508 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21509
21510 @findex pre-query
21511 @findex query
21512 @findex post-query
21513 @item query
21514 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21515
21516 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
21517 @findex prompt-for-continue
21518 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
21519 @item prompt-for-continue
21520 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21521 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21522 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21523 presence of annotations.
21524 @end table
21525
21526 @node Errors
21527 @section Errors
21528 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21529
21530 @findex quit
21531 @smallexample
21532 ^Z^Zquit
21533 @end smallexample
21534
21535 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21536
21537 @findex error
21538 @smallexample
21539 ^Z^Zerror
21540 @end smallexample
21541
21542 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21543
21544 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21545 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21546 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21547 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21548 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21549 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21550 to the top level.
21551
21552 @findex error-begin
21553 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21554
21555 @smallexample
21556 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21557 @end smallexample
21558
21559 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21560 message.
21561
21562 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21563 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21564 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21565
21566 @node Invalidation
21567 @section Invalidation Notices
21568
21569 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21570 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21571 changed.
21572
21573 @table @code
21574 @findex frames-invalid
21575 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21576
21577 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21578 have changed.
21579
21580 @findex breakpoints-invalid
21581 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21582
21583 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21584 deleted a breakpoint.
21585 @end table
21586
21587 @node Annotations for Running
21588 @section Running the Program
21589 @cindex annotations for running programs
21590
21591 @findex starting
21592 @findex stopping
21593 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21594 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21595
21596 @smallexample
21597 ^Z^Zstarting
21598 @end smallexample
21599
21600 is output. When the program stops,
21601
21602 @smallexample
21603 ^Z^Zstopped
21604 @end smallexample
21605
21606 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21607 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21608
21609 @table @code
21610 @findex exited
21611 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21612 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21613 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21614
21615 @findex signalled
21616 @findex signal-name
21617 @findex signal-name-end
21618 @findex signal-string
21619 @findex signal-string-end
21620 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21621 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21622 annotation continues:
21623
21624 @smallexample
21625 @var{intro-text}
21626 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21627 @var{name}
21628 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21629 @var{middle-text}
21630 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21631 @var{string}
21632 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21633 @var{end-text}
21634 @end smallexample
21635
21636 @noindent
21637 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21638 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21639 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21640 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21641 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21642
21643 @findex signal
21644 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21645 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21646 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21647 terminated with it.
21648
21649 @findex breakpoint
21650 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21651 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21652
21653 @findex watchpoint
21654 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21655 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21656 @end table
21657
21658 @node Source Annotations
21659 @section Displaying Source
21660 @cindex annotations for source display
21661
21662 @findex source
21663 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21664
21665 @smallexample
21666 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21667 @end smallexample
21668
21669 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21670 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21671 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21672 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21673 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21674 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21675 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21676 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21677 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21678 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21679 depend on the language).
21680
21681 @node GDB Bugs
21682 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21683 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21684 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21685
21686 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21687
21688 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21689 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21690 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21691 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21692
21693 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21694 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21695
21696 @menu
21697 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21698 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21699 @end menu
21700
21701 @node Bug Criteria
21702 @section Have you found a bug?
21703 @cindex bug criteria
21704
21705 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21706
21707 @itemize @bullet
21708 @cindex fatal signal
21709 @cindex debugger crash
21710 @cindex crash of debugger
21711 @item
21712 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21713 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21714
21715 @cindex error on valid input
21716 @item
21717 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21718 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21719 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21720
21721 @cindex invalid input
21722 @item
21723 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21724 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21725 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21726 for traditional practice''.
21727
21728 @item
21729 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21730 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21731 @end itemize
21732
21733 @node Bug Reporting
21734 @section How to report bugs
21735 @cindex bug reports
21736 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21737
21738 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21739 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21740 contact that organization first.
21741
21742 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21743 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21744 distribution.
21745 @c should add a web page ref...
21746
21747 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21748 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21749 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21750 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21751 be used.
21752
21753 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21754 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21755 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21756 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21757
21758 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21759 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21760 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21761 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21762 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21763 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21764 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21765 bug reports to the mailing list.
21766
21767 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21768 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21769 fact or leave it out, state it!
21770
21771 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21772 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21773 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21774 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21775 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21776 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21777 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21778 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21779 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21780
21781 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21782 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21783 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21784 self-contained.
21785
21786 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21787 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21788 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21789 bugs properly.
21790
21791 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21792
21793 @itemize @bullet
21794 @item
21795 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21796 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21797 version}.
21798
21799 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21800 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21801
21802 @item
21803 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21804 version number.
21805
21806 @item
21807 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21808 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21809
21810 @item
21811 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21812 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21813 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21814 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21815 compilers.
21816
21817 @item
21818 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21819 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21820 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21821 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21822
21823 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21824 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21825
21826 @item
21827 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21828 reproduce the bug.
21829
21830 @item
21831 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21832 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21833
21834 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21835 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21836 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21837 a chance to make a mistake.
21838
21839 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21840 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21841 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21842 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21843 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21844 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21845 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21846 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21847
21848 @pindex script
21849 @cindex recording a session script
21850 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21851 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21852 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21853 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21854
21855 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21856 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21857
21858 @item
21859 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21860 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21861 it by context, not by line number.
21862
21863 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21864 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21865
21866 @end itemize
21867
21868 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21869
21870 @itemize @bullet
21871 @item
21872 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21873
21874 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21875 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21876 changes will not affect it.
21877
21878 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21879 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21880 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21881 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21882
21883 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21884 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21885 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21886 less time, and so on.
21887
21888 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21889 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21890
21891 @item
21892 A patch for the bug.
21893
21894 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21895 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21896 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21897 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21898
21899 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21900 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21901 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21902 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21903
21904 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21905 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21906 help us to understand.
21907
21908 @item
21909 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21910
21911 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21912 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21913 @end itemize
21914
21915 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21916 @c and consists of the two following files:
21917 @c rluser.texinfo
21918 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21919 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21920 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21921 @include rluser.texi
21922 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21923
21924
21925 @node Formatting Documentation
21926 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21927
21928 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21929 @cindex reference card
21930 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21931 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21932 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21933 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21934 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21935 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21936
21937 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21938 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21939
21940 @smallexample
21941 make refcard.dvi
21942 @end smallexample
21943
21944 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21945 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21946 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21947 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21948 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21949
21950 @cindex documentation
21951
21952 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21953 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21954 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21955 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21956 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21957 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21958
21959 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21960 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21961 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21962 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21963 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21964 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21965 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21966 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21967
21968 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21969 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21970 @code{makeinfo}.
21971
21972 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21973 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21974 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21975
21976 @smallexample
21977 cd gdb
21978 make gdb.info
21979 @end smallexample
21980
21981 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21982 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21983 Texinfo definitions file.
21984
21985 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21986 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21987 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21988 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21989 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21990 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21991 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21992
21993 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21994 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21995 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21996 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21997 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21998 directory.
21999
22000 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22001 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
22002 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22003 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22004
22005 @smallexample
22006 make gdb.dvi
22007 @end smallexample
22008
22009 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22010
22011 @node Installing GDB
22012 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22013 @cindex installation
22014
22015 @menu
22016 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22017 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22018 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22019 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22020 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22021 @end menu
22022
22023 @node Requirements
22024 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22025 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22026
22027 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22028 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22029
22030 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22031 @table @asis
22032 @item ISO C90 compiler
22033 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22034 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22035
22036 @end table
22037
22038 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22039 @table @asis
22040 @item Expat
22041 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22042 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22043 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22044 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22045 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22046 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22047
22048 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22049 features.
22050
22051 @end table
22052
22053 @node Running Configure
22054 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22055 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22056 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22057 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22058 build the @code{gdb} program.
22059 @iftex
22060 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22061 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22062 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22063 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22064 @end iftex
22065
22066 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22067 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22068 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22069
22070 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22071 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22072
22073 @table @code
22074 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22075 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22076
22077 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22078 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22079
22080 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22081 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22082
22083 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22084 @sc{gnu} include files
22085
22086 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22087 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22088
22089 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22090 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22091
22092 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22093 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22094
22095 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22096 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22097
22098 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22099 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22100 @end table
22101
22102 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22103 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22104 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22105
22106 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22107 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22108 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22109 argument.
22110
22111 For example:
22112
22113 @smallexample
22114 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22115 ./configure @var{host}
22116 make
22117 @end smallexample
22118
22119 @noindent
22120 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22121 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22122 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22123 correct value by examining your system.)
22124
22125 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22126 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22127 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22128 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22129
22130 @need 750
22131 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22132 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22133 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22134
22135 @smallexample
22136 sh configure @var{host}
22137 @end smallexample
22138
22139 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22140 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22141 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22142 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22143 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22144
22145 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22146 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22147 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22148 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22149 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22150 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22151 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22152 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22153 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22154
22155 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22156 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22157 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22158 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22159 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22160
22161 @node Separate Objdir
22162 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22163
22164 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22165 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22166 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22167 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22168 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22169 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22170 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22171 program specified there.
22172
22173 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22174 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22175 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22176 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22177 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22178 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22179
22180 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22181 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22182
22183 @smallexample
22184 @group
22185 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22186 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22187 cd ../gdb-sun4
22188 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22189 make
22190 @end group
22191 @end smallexample
22192
22193 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22194 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22195 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22196 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22197 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22198 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22199
22200 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22201 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22202 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22203 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22204 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22205
22206 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22207 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22208 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22209 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22210 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22211 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22212
22213 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22214 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22215 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22216
22217 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22218 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22219 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22220 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22221 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22222
22223 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22224 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22225 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22226 with each other.
22227
22228 @node Config Names
22229 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22230
22231 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22232 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22233 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22234 of information in the following pattern:
22235
22236 @smallexample
22237 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22238 @end smallexample
22239
22240 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22241 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22242 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22243
22244 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22245 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22246 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22247 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22248 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22249 abbreviations---for example:
22250
22251 @smallexample
22252 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22253 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22254 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22255 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22256 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22257 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22258 % sh config.sub sun4
22259 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22260 % sh config.sub sun3
22261 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22262 % sh config.sub i986v
22263 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22264 @end smallexample
22265
22266 @noindent
22267 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22268 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22269
22270 @node Configure Options
22271 @section @code{configure} options
22272
22273 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22274 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22275 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22276 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22277
22278 @smallexample
22279 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22280 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22281 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22282 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22283 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22284 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22285 @var{host}
22286 @end smallexample
22287
22288 @noindent
22289 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22290 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22291 @samp{--}.
22292
22293 @table @code
22294 @item --help
22295 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22296
22297 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22298 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22299 @file{@var{dir}}.
22300
22301 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22302 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22303 @file{@var{dir}}.
22304
22305 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22306 @need 2000
22307 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22308 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22309 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22310 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22311 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22312 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22313 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22314 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22315 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22316 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22317 @var{dirname}.
22318
22319 @item --norecursion
22320 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22321 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22322
22323 @item --target=@var{target}
22324 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22325 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22326 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22327
22328 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22329
22330 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22331 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22332
22333 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22334 @end table
22335
22336 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22337 needed for special purposes only.
22338
22339 @node Maintenance Commands
22340 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22341 @cindex maintenance commands
22342 @cindex internal commands
22343
22344 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22345 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22346 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22347 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22348 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22349
22350 @table @code
22351 @kindex maint agent
22352 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22353 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22354 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22355 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22356
22357 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22358 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22359 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22360 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22361 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22362 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22363 is shown:
22364
22365 @table @code
22366 @item breakpoint
22367 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22368
22369 @item watchpoint
22370 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22371
22372 @item longjmp
22373 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22374 @code{longjmp} calls.
22375
22376 @item longjmp resume
22377 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22378
22379 @item until
22380 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22381
22382 @item finish
22383 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22384
22385 @item shlib events
22386 Shared library events.
22387
22388 @end table
22389
22390 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22391 @item maint check-symtabs
22392 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22393
22394 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22395 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22396 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22397
22398 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22399 @item maint cplus namespace
22400 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22401
22402 @kindex maint demangle
22403 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22404 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22405
22406 @kindex maint deprecate
22407 @kindex maint undeprecate
22408 @cindex deprecated commands
22409 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22410 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22411 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22412 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22413 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22414 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22415 the replacement as part of the warning.
22416
22417 @kindex maint dump-me
22418 @item maint dump-me
22419 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22420 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22421 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22422 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22423
22424 @kindex maint internal-error
22425 @kindex maint internal-warning
22426 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22427 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22428 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22429 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22430 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22431 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22432 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22433 @value{GDBN} session.
22434
22435 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22436 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22437
22438 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22439
22440 @smallexample
22441 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22442 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22443 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22444 debugging may prove unreliable.
22445 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22446 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22447 (@value{GDBP})
22448 @end smallexample
22449
22450 @kindex maint packet
22451 @item maint packet @var{text}
22452 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22453 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22454 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22455 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22456 checksum.
22457
22458 @kindex maint print architecture
22459 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22460 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22461 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22462
22463 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22464 @item maint print dummy-frames
22465 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22466
22467 @smallexample
22468 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22469 @dots{}
22470 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22471 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22472 58 return (a + b);
22473 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22474 @dots{}
22475 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22476 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22477 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22478 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22479 (@value{GDBP})
22480 @end smallexample
22481
22482 Takes an optional file parameter.
22483
22484 @kindex maint print registers
22485 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22486 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22487 @kindex maint print register-groups
22488 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22489 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22490 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22491 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22492 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22493
22494 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22495 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22496 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22497 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22498 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22499 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22500
22501 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22502 write the information.
22503
22504 @kindex maint print reggroups
22505 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22506 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22507 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22508 information.
22509
22510 The register groups info looks like this:
22511
22512 @smallexample
22513 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22514 Group Type
22515 general user
22516 float user
22517 all user
22518 vector user
22519 system user
22520 save internal
22521 restore internal
22522 @end smallexample
22523
22524 @kindex flushregs
22525 @item flushregs
22526 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22527
22528 @kindex maint print objfiles
22529 @cindex info for known object files
22530 @item maint print objfiles
22531 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22532 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22533 and symtabs.
22534
22535 @kindex maint print statistics
22536 @cindex bcache statistics
22537 @item maint print statistics
22538 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22539 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22540 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22541 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22542 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22543 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22544 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22545 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22546 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22547 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22548 lengths.
22549
22550 @kindex maint print type
22551 @cindex type chain of a data type
22552 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22553 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22554 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22555 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22556 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22557 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22558
22559 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22560 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22561 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22562 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22563 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22564
22565 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22566 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22567 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22568 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22569 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22570 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22571 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22572 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22573 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22574
22575 @kindex maint set profile
22576 @kindex maint show profile
22577 @cindex profiling GDB
22578 @item maint set profile
22579 @itemx maint show profile
22580 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22581
22582 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22583 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22584 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22585 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22586 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22587 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22588 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22589
22590 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22591 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22592
22593 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22594 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22595 @item maint show-debug-regs
22596 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22597 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22598 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22599 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22600 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22601
22602 @kindex maint space
22603 @cindex memory used by commands
22604 @item maint space
22605 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22606 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22607 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22608 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22609 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22610
22611 @kindex maint time
22612 @cindex time of command execution
22613 @item maint time
22614 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22615 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22616 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22617 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22618 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22619
22620 @kindex maint translate-address
22621 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22622 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22623 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22624 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22625 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22626 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22627 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22628
22629 @end table
22630
22631 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22632 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22633
22634 @table @code
22635 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22636 @kindex set watchdog
22637 @cindex watchdog timer
22638 @cindex timeout for commands
22639 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22640 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22641 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22642
22643 @item show watchdog
22644 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22645 @end table
22646
22647 @node Remote Protocol
22648 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22649
22650 @menu
22651 * Overview::
22652 * Packets::
22653 * Stop Reply Packets::
22654 * General Query Packets::
22655 * Register Packet Format::
22656 * Tracepoint Packets::
22657 * Interrupts::
22658 * Examples::
22659 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22660 * Memory map format::
22661 @end menu
22662
22663 @node Overview
22664 @section Overview
22665
22666 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22667 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22668 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22669 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22670
22671 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22672 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22673
22674 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22675 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22676 @cindex remote serial protocol
22677 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22678 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22679 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22680 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22681
22682 @smallexample
22683 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22684 @end smallexample
22685 @noindent
22686
22687 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22688 @noindent
22689 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22690 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22691 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22692
22693 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22694 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22695
22696 @smallexample
22697 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22698 @end smallexample
22699
22700 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22701 @noindent
22702 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22703 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22704 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22705
22706 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22707 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22708 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22709 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22710 retransmission):
22711
22712 @smallexample
22713 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22714 <- @code{+}
22715 @end smallexample
22716 @noindent
22717
22718 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22719 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22720 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22721 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22722
22723 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22724 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22725 exceptions).
22726
22727 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22728 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22729 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22730 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22731
22732 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22733 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22734 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22735
22736 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22737 @anchor{Binary Data}
22738 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22739 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22740 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22741 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22742 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22743 binary data.
22744
22745 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22746 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22747 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22748 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22749 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22750 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22751 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22752 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22753 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22754 (described next).
22755
22756 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22757 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22758 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22759 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22760 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22761 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22762 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22763
22764 So:
22765 @smallexample
22766 "@code{0* }"
22767 @end smallexample
22768 @noindent
22769 means the same as "0000".
22770
22771 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22772 error number. That number is not well defined.
22773
22774 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22775 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22776 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22777 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22778 on that response.
22779
22780 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22781 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22782 optional.
22783
22784 @node Packets
22785 @section Packets
22786
22787 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22788 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22789 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22790 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22791
22792 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22793 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22794 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22795 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22796 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22797 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22798 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22799 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22800 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22801 @var{baz}.
22802
22803 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22804 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22805
22806 Here are the packet descriptions.
22807
22808 @table @samp
22809
22810 @item !
22811 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22812 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22813 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22814 debugged.
22815
22816 Reply:
22817 @table @samp
22818 @item OK
22819 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22820 @end table
22821
22822 @item ?
22823 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22824 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22825 step and continue.
22826
22827 Reply:
22828 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22829
22830 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22831 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22832 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22833 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22834 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22835
22836 Reply:
22837 @table @samp
22838 @item OK
22839 The arguments were set.
22840 @item E @var{NN}
22841 An error occurred.
22842 @end table
22843
22844 @item b @var{baud}
22845 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22846 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22847 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22848
22849 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22850 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22851 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22852
22853 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22854 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22855 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22856 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22857 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22858
22859 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22860 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22861 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22862 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22863
22864 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22865 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22866
22867 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22868 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22869 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22870 resume at current address.
22871
22872 Reply:
22873 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22874
22875 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22876 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22877 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22878 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22879
22880 Reply:
22881 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22882
22883 @item d
22884 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22885 Toggle debug flag.
22886
22887 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22888 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22889
22890 @item D
22891 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22892 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22893 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22894
22895 Reply:
22896 @table @samp
22897 @item OK
22898 for success
22899 @item E @var{NN}
22900 for an error
22901 @end table
22902
22903 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22904 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22905 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22906 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22907 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22908
22909 @item g
22910 @anchor{read registers packet}
22911 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22912 Read general registers.
22913
22914 Reply:
22915 @table @samp
22916 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22917 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22918 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22919 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22920 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22921 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22922 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22923 @item E @var{NN}
22924 for an error.
22925 @end table
22926
22927 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22928 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22929 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22930 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22931
22932 Reply:
22933 @table @samp
22934 @item OK
22935 for success
22936 @item E @var{NN}
22937 for an error
22938 @end table
22939
22940 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22941 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22942 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22943 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22944 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22945 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22946 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22947
22948 Reply:
22949 @table @samp
22950 @item OK
22951 for success
22952 @item E @var{NN}
22953 for an error
22954 @end table
22955
22956 @c FIXME: JTC:
22957 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22958 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22959 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22960 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22961 @c described. For example:
22962 @c
22963 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22964 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22965 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22966 @c
22967 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22968 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22969 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22970
22971 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22972 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22973 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22974 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22975 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22976 step starting at that address.
22977
22978 @item I
22979 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22980 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22981 step packet}.
22982
22983 @item k
22984 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22985 Kill request.
22986
22987 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22988 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22989 thread?)}.
22990
22991 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22992 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22993 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22994 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22995
22996 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22997 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22998 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22999 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23000 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23001 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23002 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23003 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23004
23005 Reply:
23006 @table @samp
23007 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23008 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23009 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23010 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23011 @item E @var{NN}
23012 @var{NN} is errno
23013 @end table
23014
23015 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23016 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23017 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23018 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23019 hexadecimal number.
23020
23021 Reply:
23022 @table @samp
23023 @item OK
23024 for success
23025 @item E @var{NN}
23026 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23027 written).
23028 @end table
23029
23030 @item p @var{n}
23031 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23032 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23033 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23034 register value is encoded.
23035
23036 Reply:
23037 @table @samp
23038 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23039 the register's value
23040 @item E @var{NN}
23041 for an error
23042 @item
23043 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23044 @end table
23045
23046 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23047 @anchor{write register packet}
23048 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23049 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23050 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23051 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23052
23053 Reply:
23054 @table @samp
23055 @item OK
23056 for success
23057 @item E @var{NN}
23058 for an error
23059 @end table
23060
23061 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23062 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23063 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23064 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23065 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23066 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23067
23068 @item r
23069 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23070 Reset the entire system.
23071
23072 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23073
23074 @item R @var{XX}
23075 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23076 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23077 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23078
23079 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23080
23081 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23082 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23083 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23084 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23085
23086 Reply:
23087 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23088
23089 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23090 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23091 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23092 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23093 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23094
23095 Reply:
23096 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23097
23098 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23099 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23100 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23101 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23102 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23103
23104 @item T @var{XX}
23105 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23106 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23107
23108 Reply:
23109 @table @samp
23110 @item OK
23111 thread is still alive
23112 @item E @var{NN}
23113 thread is dead
23114 @end table
23115
23116 @item v
23117 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23118 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23119
23120 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23121 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23122 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23123 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23124 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23125 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23126 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23127 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23128
23129 @table @samp
23130 @item c
23131 Continue.
23132 @item C @var{sig}
23133 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23134 @item s
23135 Step.
23136 @item S @var{sig}
23137 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23138 @end table
23139
23140 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23141 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23142
23143 Reply:
23144 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23145
23146 @item vCont?
23147 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23148 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23149
23150 Reply:
23151 @table @samp
23152 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23153 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23154 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23155 @item
23156 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23157 @end table
23158
23159 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23160 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23161 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23162 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23163 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23164 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23165 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23166 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23167 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23168 packet is received.
23169
23170 Reply:
23171 @table @samp
23172 @item OK
23173 for success
23174 @item E @var{NN}
23175 for an error
23176 @end table
23177
23178 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23179 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23180 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23181 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23182 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23183 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23184 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23185 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23186 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23187 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23188 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23189 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23190
23191
23192 Reply:
23193 @table @samp
23194 @item OK
23195 for success
23196 @item E.memtype
23197 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23198 @item E @var{NN}
23199 for an error
23200 @end table
23201
23202 @item vFlashDone
23203 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23204 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23205 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23206 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23207 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23208 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23209 request is completed.
23210
23211 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23212 @anchor{X packet}
23213 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23214 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23215 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23216 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23217
23218 Reply:
23219 @table @samp
23220 @item OK
23221 for success
23222 @item E @var{NN}
23223 for an error
23224 @end table
23225
23226 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23227 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23228 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23229 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23230 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23231 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23232 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23233 @var{length} bytes.
23234
23235 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23236 separately.
23237
23238 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23239 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23240 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23241 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23242 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23243 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23244
23245 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23246 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23247 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23248 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23249 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23250 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23251
23252 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23253 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23254 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23255 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23256 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23257
23258 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23259 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23260 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23261 target, is not defined.}
23262
23263 Reply:
23264 @table @samp
23265 @item OK
23266 success
23267 @item
23268 not supported
23269 @item E @var{NN}
23270 for an error
23271 @end table
23272
23273 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23274 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23275 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23276 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23277 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23278 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23279
23280 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23281 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23282
23283 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23284 movement.}
23285
23286 Reply:
23287 @table @samp
23288 @item OK
23289 success
23290 @item
23291 not supported
23292 @item E @var{NN}
23293 for an error
23294 @end table
23295
23296 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23297 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23298 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23299 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23300 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23301
23302 Reply:
23303 @table @samp
23304 @item OK
23305 success
23306 @item
23307 not supported
23308 @item E @var{NN}
23309 for an error
23310 @end table
23311
23312 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23313 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23314 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23315 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23316 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23317
23318 Reply:
23319 @table @samp
23320 @item OK
23321 success
23322 @item
23323 not supported
23324 @item E @var{NN}
23325 for an error
23326 @end table
23327
23328 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23329 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23330 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23331 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23332 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23333
23334 Reply:
23335 @table @samp
23336 @item OK
23337 success
23338 @item
23339 not supported
23340 @item E @var{NN}
23341 for an error
23342 @end table
23343
23344 @end table
23345
23346 @node Stop Reply Packets
23347 @section Stop Reply Packets
23348 @cindex stop reply packets
23349
23350 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23351 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23352 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23353 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23354 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
23355 numbering conventions is used.
23356
23357 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23358 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23359 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23360 components.
23361
23362 @table @samp
23363
23364 @item S @var{AA}
23365 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23366 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23367 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23368
23369 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23370 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23371 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23372 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23373 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23374 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23375 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23376 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23377 @enumerate
23378 @item
23379 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23380 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23381 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23382 two-digit hex number.
23383 @item
23384 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23385 hex.
23386 @item
23387 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23388 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23389 hex.
23390 @item
23391 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23392 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23393 future.
23394 @end enumerate
23395
23396 @item W @var{AA}
23397 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23398 applicable to certain targets.
23399
23400 @item X @var{AA}
23401 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23402
23403 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23404 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23405 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23406 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23407 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23408
23409 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23410 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23411 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23412 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23413 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23414 system calls.
23415
23416 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23417 this very system call.
23418
23419 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23420 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23421 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23422 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23423 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23424 protocol extension}, for more details.
23425
23426 @end table
23427
23428 @node General Query Packets
23429 @section General Query Packets
23430 @cindex remote query requests
23431
23432 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23433 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23434 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23435 sending information to and from the stub.
23436
23437 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23438 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23439 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23440 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23441 conventions:
23442
23443 @itemize @bullet
23444 @item
23445 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23446 @item
23447 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23448 letter.
23449 @item
23450 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23451 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23452 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23453 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23454 @end itemize
23455
23456 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23457 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23458 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23459 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23460 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23461 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23462 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23463 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23464 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23465 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23466 packet.}.
23467
23468 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23469 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23470 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23471 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23472 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23473
23474 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23475
23476 @table @samp
23477
23478 @item qC
23479 @cindex current thread, remote request
23480 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23481 Return the current thread id.
23482
23483 Reply:
23484 @table @samp
23485 @item QC @var{pid}
23486 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23487 @item @r{(anything else)}
23488 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23489 @end table
23490
23491 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23492 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23493 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23494 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23495 Reply:
23496 @table @samp
23497 @item E @var{NN}
23498 An error (such as memory fault)
23499 @item C @var{crc32}
23500 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23501 @end table
23502
23503 @item qfThreadInfo
23504 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23505 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23506 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23507 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23508 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23509 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23510 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23511 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23512 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23513 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23514
23515 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23516
23517 Reply:
23518 @table @samp
23519 @item m @var{id}
23520 A single thread id
23521 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23522 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23523 @item l
23524 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23525 @end table
23526
23527 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23528 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23529 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23530 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23531 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23532
23533 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23534 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23535 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23536 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23537 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23538
23539 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23540 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23541
23542 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23543 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23544 information associated with the variable.)
23545
23546 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23547 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23548 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23549 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23550 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23551 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23552
23553 Reply:
23554 @table @samp
23555 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23556 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23557 local storage requested.
23558
23559 @item E @var{nn}
23560 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23561
23562 @item
23563 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23564 @end table
23565
23566 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
23567 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
23568 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
23569
23570 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23571 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23572 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23573 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23574 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23575 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23576 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23577
23578 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23579
23580 Reply:
23581 @table @samp
23582 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23583 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23584 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23585 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23586 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23587 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23588 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23589 @end table
23590
23591 @item qOffsets
23592 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23593 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23594 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23595 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23596 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23597 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23598
23599 Reply:
23600 @table @samp
23601 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23602 @end table
23603
23604 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23605 @cindex thread information, remote request
23606 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23607 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23608 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23609
23610 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23611 (see below).
23612
23613 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23614
23615 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23616 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23617 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23618 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23619 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23620 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23621 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23622 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23623 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23624
23625 Reply:
23626 @table @samp
23627 @item OK
23628 A command response with no output.
23629 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23630 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23631 @item E @var{NN}
23632 Indicate a badly formed request.
23633 @item
23634 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23635 @end table
23636
23637 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23638 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23639 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23640 packets.)
23641
23642 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23643 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23644 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23645 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23646 @anchor{qSupported}
23647 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23648 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23649 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23650 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23651 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23652 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23653 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23654 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23655 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23656 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23657 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23658 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23659 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23660 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23661
23662 Reply:
23663 @table @samp
23664 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23665 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23666 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23667 possible forms).
23668 @item
23669 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23670 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23671 @end table
23672
23673 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23674 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23675 are:
23676
23677 @table @samp
23678 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23679 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23680 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23681 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23682 @item @var{name}+
23683 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23684 need an associated value.
23685 @item @var{name}-
23686 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23687 @item @var{name}?
23688 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23689 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23690 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23691 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23692 @end table
23693
23694 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23695 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23696 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23697 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23698 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23699
23700 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23701 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23702 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23703 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23704 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23705 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23706 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23707 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23708 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23709 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23710 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23711 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23712 all the features it supports.
23713
23714 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23715 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23716
23717 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23718 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23719 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23720 form response.
23721
23722 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23723 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23724 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23725 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23726
23727 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23728 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23729 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23730 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23731 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23732
23733 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23734
23735 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23736 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23737 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23738 @item Feature Name
23739 @tab Value Required
23740 @tab Default
23741 @tab Probe Allowed
23742
23743 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23744 @tab Yes
23745 @tab @samp{-}
23746 @tab No
23747
23748 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23749 @tab No
23750 @tab @samp{-}
23751 @tab Yes
23752
23753 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23754 @tab No
23755 @tab @samp{-}
23756 @tab Yes
23757
23758 @end multitable
23759
23760 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23761
23762 @table @samp
23763 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23764 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23765 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23766 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23767 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23768 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23769 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23770 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23771 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23772 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23773
23774 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23775 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23776 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23777
23778 @end table
23779
23780 @item qSymbol::
23781 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23782 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23783 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23784 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23785
23786 Reply:
23787 @table @samp
23788 @item OK
23789 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23790 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23791 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23792 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23793 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23794 below.
23795 @end table
23796
23797 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23798 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23799
23800 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23801 target has previously requested.
23802
23803 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23804 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23805 will be empty.
23806
23807 Reply:
23808 @table @samp
23809 @item OK
23810 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23811 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23812 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23813 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23814 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23815 @end table
23816
23817 @item QTDP
23818 @itemx QTFrame
23819 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23820
23821 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23822 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23823 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23824 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23825 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23826 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23827 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23828 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23829 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23830 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23831
23832 Reply:
23833 @table @samp
23834 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23835 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23836 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23837 the thread's attributes.
23838 @end table
23839
23840 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23841 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23842 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23843 packets.)
23844
23845 @item QTStart
23846 @itemx QTStop
23847 @itemx QTinit
23848 @itemx QTro
23849 @itemx qTStatus
23850 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23851
23852 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23853 @cindex read special object, remote request
23854 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23855 @anchor{qXfer read}
23856 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23857 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23858 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23859 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23860 additional details about what data to access.
23861
23862 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23863 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23864 formats, listed below.
23865
23866 @table @samp
23867 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23868 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23869 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23870 auxiliary vector}, and @ref{Remote configuration,
23871 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23872
23873 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23874 by suppling an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23875 @end table
23876
23877 @table @samp
23878 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23879 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23880 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
23881 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23882 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23883
23884 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23885 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23886 @end table
23887
23888 Reply:
23889 @table @samp
23890 @item m @var{data}
23891 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23892 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23893 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23894 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23895 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23896 request.
23897
23898 @item l @var{data}
23899 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23900 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23901 than the @var{length} in the request.
23902
23903 @item l
23904 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23905 There is no more data to be read.
23906
23907 @item E00
23908 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23909
23910 @item E @var{nn}
23911 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23912 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23913
23914 @item
23915 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23916 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23917 @end table
23918
23919 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23920 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23921 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23922 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23923 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23924 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23925 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23926 to access.
23927
23928 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23929 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23930 specific request specifications ought to use.
23931
23932 Reply:
23933 @table @samp
23934 @item @var{nn}
23935 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23936 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23937
23938 @item E00
23939 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23940
23941 @item E @var{nn}
23942 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23943 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23944
23945 @item
23946 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23947 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23948 @end table
23949
23950 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23951 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23952 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23953 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23954 must respond with an empty packet.
23955
23956 @end table
23957
23958 @node Register Packet Format
23959 @section Register Packet Format
23960
23961 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23962 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23963 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23964 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23965 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23966 most-significant - least-significant.
23967
23968 @table @r
23969
23970 @item MIPS32
23971
23972 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23973 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23974 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23975
23976 @item MIPS64
23977
23978 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23979 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23980 as @code{MIPS32}.
23981
23982 @end table
23983
23984 @node Tracepoint Packets
23985 @section Tracepoint Packets
23986 @cindex tracepoint packets
23987 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23988
23989 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23990 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23991
23992 @table @samp
23993
23994 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23995 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23996 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23997 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23998 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23999 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24000 tracepoint's actions.
24001
24002 Replies:
24003 @table @samp
24004 @item OK
24005 The packet was understood and carried out.
24006 @item
24007 The packet was not recognized.
24008 @end table
24009
24010 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24011 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24012 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24013 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24014 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24015 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24016 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24017
24018 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24019 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24020 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24021 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24022 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24023 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24024 tracepoint actions.
24025
24026 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24027 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24028 following forms:
24029
24030 @table @samp
24031
24032 @item R @var{mask}
24033 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24034 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24035 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24036 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24037 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24038
24039 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24040 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24041 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24042 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24043 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24044 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24045 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24046
24047 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24048 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24049 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24050 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24051 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24052 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24053 packet).
24054
24055 @end table
24056
24057 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24058 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24059 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24060 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24061 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24062 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24063 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24064 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24065
24066 Replies:
24067 @table @samp
24068 @item OK
24069 The packet was understood and carried out.
24070 @item
24071 The packet was not recognized.
24072 @end table
24073
24074 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24075 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24076 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24077 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24078
24079 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24080 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24081 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24082 one of the following forms:
24083
24084 @table @samp
24085 @item F @var{f}
24086 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24087 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24088 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24089
24090 @item T @var{t}
24091 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24092 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24093
24094 @end table
24095
24096 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24097 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24098 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24099 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24100
24101 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24102 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24103 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24104 is a hexadecimal number.
24105
24106 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24107 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24108 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24109 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24110 numbers.
24111
24112 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24113 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24114 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24115
24116 @item QTStart
24117 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24118 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24119
24120 @item QTStop
24121 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24122
24123 @item QTinit
24124 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24125
24126 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24127 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24128 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24129 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24130
24131 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24132 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24133 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24134 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24135
24136 @item qTStatus
24137 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24138
24139 Replies:
24140 @table @samp
24141 @item T0
24142 There is no trace experiment running.
24143 @item T1
24144 There is a trace experiment running.
24145 @end table
24146
24147 @end table
24148
24149
24150 @node Interrupts
24151 @section Interrupts
24152 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24153
24154 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24155 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24156 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24157 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24158
24159 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24160 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24161 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24162 interfaces.
24163
24164 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24165 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24166 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24167 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24168 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24169 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24170 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24171 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24172
24173 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24174 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24175 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24176 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24177 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24178 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24179 program is stopped will be discarded.
24180
24181 @node Examples
24182 @section Examples
24183
24184 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24185 does not get any direct output:
24186
24187 @smallexample
24188 -> @code{R00}
24189 <- @code{+}
24190 @emph{target restarts}
24191 -> @code{?}
24192 <- @code{+}
24193 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24194 -> @code{+}
24195 @end smallexample
24196
24197 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24198
24199 @smallexample
24200 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24201 <- @code{+}
24202 -> @code{s}
24203 <- @code{+}
24204 @emph{time passes}
24205 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24206 -> @code{+}
24207 -> @code{g}
24208 <- @code{+}
24209 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24210 -> @code{+}
24211 @end smallexample
24212
24213 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24214 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24215 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24216
24217 @menu
24218 * File-I/O Overview::
24219 * Protocol basics::
24220 * The F request packet::
24221 * The F reply packet::
24222 * The Ctrl-C message::
24223 * Console I/O::
24224 * List of supported calls::
24225 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24226 * Constants::
24227 * File-I/O Examples::
24228 @end menu
24229
24230 @node File-I/O Overview
24231 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24232 @cindex file-i/o overview
24233
24234 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24235 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24236 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24237 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24238 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24239 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24240
24241 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24242 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24243 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24244 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24245 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24246
24247 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24248 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24249 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24250 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24251 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24252 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24253 (Ctrl-C) within @value{GDBN}.
24254
24255 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24256 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24257 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24258 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24259 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24260
24261 @smallexample
24262 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24263 <- target requests 'system call X'
24264 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24265 -> GDB returns result
24266 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24267 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24268 @end smallexample
24269
24270 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24271 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24272 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24273 system are not supported by this protocol.
24274
24275 @node Protocol basics
24276 @subsection Protocol basics
24277 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24278
24279 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24280 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24281 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24282 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24283 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24284 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24285 to call the appropriate host system call:
24286
24287 @itemize @bullet
24288 @item
24289 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24290
24291 @item
24292 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24293 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24294 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24295 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24296
24297 @end itemize
24298
24299 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24300
24301 @itemize @bullet
24302 @item
24303 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24304 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24305 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24306 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24307 packet.
24308
24309 @item
24310 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24311 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24312
24313 @item
24314 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24315
24316 @item
24317 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24318
24319 @item
24320 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24321 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24322 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24323 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24324 packet.
24325
24326 @end itemize
24327
24328 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24329 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24330
24331 @itemize @bullet
24332 @item
24333 Return value.
24334
24335 @item
24336 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24337
24338 @item
24339 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24340
24341 @end itemize
24342
24343 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24344 the latest continue or step action.
24345
24346 @node The F request packet
24347 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24348 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24349 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24350
24351 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24352
24353 @table @samp
24354 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24355
24356 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24357 This is just the name of the function.
24358
24359 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24360 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24361 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24362 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24363 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24364 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24365 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24366
24367 @end table
24368
24369
24370
24371 @node The F reply packet
24372 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24373 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24374 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24375
24376 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24377
24378 @table @samp
24379
24380 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24381
24382 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24383
24384 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24385 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24386
24387 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24388 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24389 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24390
24391 @smallexample
24392 F0,0,C
24393 @end smallexample
24394
24395 @noindent
24396 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24397
24398 @smallexample
24399 F-1,4,C
24400 @end smallexample
24401
24402 @noindent
24403 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24404
24405 @end table
24406
24407
24408 @node The Ctrl-C message
24409 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
24410 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24411
24412 If the Ctrl-C flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24413 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24414 the target should behave as if it had
24415 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24416 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24417 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24418 packet.
24419
24420 It's important for the target to know in which
24421 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24422
24423 @itemize @bullet
24424 @item
24425 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24426
24427 @item
24428 The system call on the host has been finished.
24429
24430 @end itemize
24431
24432 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24433 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24434 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24435 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24436 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24437 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24438
24439 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24440 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24441 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24442 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24443 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24444 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24445 or the full action has been completed.
24446
24447 @node Console I/O
24448 @subsection Console I/O
24449 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24450
24451 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24452 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24453 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24454 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24455 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24456 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24457 conditions is met:
24458
24459 @itemize @bullet
24460 @item
24461 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24462 @code{read}
24463 system call is treated as finished.
24464
24465 @item
24466 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24467 newline.
24468
24469 @item
24470 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24471 character (neither newline nor Ctrl-D) is appended to the input.
24472
24473 @end itemize
24474
24475 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24476 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24477 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24478 is stopped at the user's request.
24479
24480
24481 @node List of supported calls
24482 @subsection List of supported calls
24483 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24484
24485 @menu
24486 * open::
24487 * close::
24488 * read::
24489 * write::
24490 * lseek::
24491 * rename::
24492 * unlink::
24493 * stat/fstat::
24494 * gettimeofday::
24495 * isatty::
24496 * system::
24497 @end menu
24498
24499 @node open
24500 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24501 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24502
24503 @table @asis
24504 @item Synopsis:
24505 @smallexample
24506 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24507 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24508 @end smallexample
24509
24510 @item Request:
24511 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24512
24513 @noindent
24514 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24515
24516 @table @code
24517 @item O_CREAT
24518 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24519 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24520 are concerned.
24521
24522 @item O_EXCL
24523 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24524 an error and open() fails.
24525
24526 @item O_TRUNC
24527 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24528 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24529 truncated to zero length.
24530
24531 @item O_APPEND
24532 The file is opened in append mode.
24533
24534 @item O_RDONLY
24535 The file is opened for reading only.
24536
24537 @item O_WRONLY
24538 The file is opened for writing only.
24539
24540 @item O_RDWR
24541 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24542 @end table
24543
24544 @noindent
24545 Other bits are silently ignored.
24546
24547
24548 @noindent
24549 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24550
24551 @table @code
24552 @item S_IRUSR
24553 User has read permission.
24554
24555 @item S_IWUSR
24556 User has write permission.
24557
24558 @item S_IRGRP
24559 Group has read permission.
24560
24561 @item S_IWGRP
24562 Group has write permission.
24563
24564 @item S_IROTH
24565 Others have read permission.
24566
24567 @item S_IWOTH
24568 Others have write permission.
24569 @end table
24570
24571 @noindent
24572 Other bits are silently ignored.
24573
24574
24575 @item Return value:
24576 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24577 occurred.
24578
24579 @item Errors:
24580
24581 @table @code
24582 @item EEXIST
24583 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24584
24585 @item EISDIR
24586 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24587
24588 @item EACCES
24589 The requested access is not allowed.
24590
24591 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24592 @var{pathname} was too long.
24593
24594 @item ENOENT
24595 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24596
24597 @item ENODEV
24598 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24599
24600 @item EROFS
24601 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24602 write access was requested.
24603
24604 @item EFAULT
24605 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24606
24607 @item ENOSPC
24608 No space on device to create the file.
24609
24610 @item EMFILE
24611 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24612
24613 @item ENFILE
24614 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24615 has been reached.
24616
24617 @item EINTR
24618 The call was interrupted by the user.
24619 @end table
24620
24621 @end table
24622
24623 @node close
24624 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24625 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24626
24627 @table @asis
24628 @item Synopsis:
24629 @smallexample
24630 int close(int fd);
24631 @end smallexample
24632
24633 @item Request:
24634 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24635
24636 @item Return value:
24637 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24638
24639 @item Errors:
24640
24641 @table @code
24642 @item EBADF
24643 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24644
24645 @item EINTR
24646 The call was interrupted by the user.
24647 @end table
24648
24649 @end table
24650
24651 @node read
24652 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24653 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24654
24655 @table @asis
24656 @item Synopsis:
24657 @smallexample
24658 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24659 @end smallexample
24660
24661 @item Request:
24662 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24663
24664 @item Return value:
24665 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24666 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24667 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24668
24669 @item Errors:
24670
24671 @table @code
24672 @item EBADF
24673 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24674 reading.
24675
24676 @item EFAULT
24677 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24678
24679 @item EINTR
24680 The call was interrupted by the user.
24681 @end table
24682
24683 @end table
24684
24685 @node write
24686 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24687 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24688
24689 @table @asis
24690 @item Synopsis:
24691 @smallexample
24692 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24693 @end smallexample
24694
24695 @item Request:
24696 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24697
24698 @item Return value:
24699 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24700 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24701 is returned.
24702
24703 @item Errors:
24704
24705 @table @code
24706 @item EBADF
24707 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24708 writing.
24709
24710 @item EFAULT
24711 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24712
24713 @item EFBIG
24714 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24715 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24716
24717 @item ENOSPC
24718 No space on device to write the data.
24719
24720 @item EINTR
24721 The call was interrupted by the user.
24722 @end table
24723
24724 @end table
24725
24726 @node lseek
24727 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24728 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24729
24730 @table @asis
24731 @item Synopsis:
24732 @smallexample
24733 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24734 @end smallexample
24735
24736 @item Request:
24737 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24738
24739 @var{flag} is one of:
24740
24741 @table @code
24742 @item SEEK_SET
24743 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24744
24745 @item SEEK_CUR
24746 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24747 bytes.
24748
24749 @item SEEK_END
24750 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24751 bytes.
24752 @end table
24753
24754 @item Return value:
24755 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24756 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24757 value of -1 is returned.
24758
24759 @item Errors:
24760
24761 @table @code
24762 @item EBADF
24763 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24764
24765 @item ESPIPE
24766 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24767
24768 @item EINVAL
24769 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24770
24771 @item EINTR
24772 The call was interrupted by the user.
24773 @end table
24774
24775 @end table
24776
24777 @node rename
24778 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24779 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24780
24781 @table @asis
24782 @item Synopsis:
24783 @smallexample
24784 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24785 @end smallexample
24786
24787 @item Request:
24788 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24789
24790 @item Return value:
24791 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24792
24793 @item Errors:
24794
24795 @table @code
24796 @item EISDIR
24797 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24798 directory.
24799
24800 @item EEXIST
24801 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24802
24803 @item EBUSY
24804 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24805 process.
24806
24807 @item EINVAL
24808 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24809 of itself.
24810
24811 @item ENOTDIR
24812 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24813 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24814 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24815
24816 @item EFAULT
24817 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24818
24819 @item EACCES
24820 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24821
24822 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24823
24824 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24825
24826 @item ENOENT
24827 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24828
24829 @item EROFS
24830 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24831
24832 @item ENOSPC
24833 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24834 directory entry.
24835
24836 @item EINTR
24837 The call was interrupted by the user.
24838 @end table
24839
24840 @end table
24841
24842 @node unlink
24843 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24844 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24845
24846 @table @asis
24847 @item Synopsis:
24848 @smallexample
24849 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24850 @end smallexample
24851
24852 @item Request:
24853 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24854
24855 @item Return value:
24856 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24857
24858 @item Errors:
24859
24860 @table @code
24861 @item EACCES
24862 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24863
24864 @item EPERM
24865 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24866
24867 @item EBUSY
24868 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24869 being used by another process.
24870
24871 @item EFAULT
24872 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24873
24874 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24875 @var{pathname} was too long.
24876
24877 @item ENOENT
24878 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24879
24880 @item ENOTDIR
24881 A component of the path is not a directory.
24882
24883 @item EROFS
24884 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24885
24886 @item EINTR
24887 The call was interrupted by the user.
24888 @end table
24889
24890 @end table
24891
24892 @node stat/fstat
24893 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24894 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24895 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24896
24897 @table @asis
24898 @item Synopsis:
24899 @smallexample
24900 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24901 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24902 @end smallexample
24903
24904 @item Request:
24905 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24906 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24907
24908 @item Return value:
24909 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24910
24911 @item Errors:
24912
24913 @table @code
24914 @item EBADF
24915 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24916
24917 @item ENOENT
24918 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24919 path is an empty string.
24920
24921 @item ENOTDIR
24922 A component of the path is not a directory.
24923
24924 @item EFAULT
24925 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24926
24927 @item EACCES
24928 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24929
24930 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24931 @var{pathname} was too long.
24932
24933 @item EINTR
24934 The call was interrupted by the user.
24935 @end table
24936
24937 @end table
24938
24939 @node gettimeofday
24940 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24941 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24942
24943 @table @asis
24944 @item Synopsis:
24945 @smallexample
24946 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24947 @end smallexample
24948
24949 @item Request:
24950 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24951
24952 @item Return value:
24953 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24954
24955 @item Errors:
24956
24957 @table @code
24958 @item EINVAL
24959 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24960
24961 @item EFAULT
24962 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24963 @end table
24964
24965 @end table
24966
24967 @node isatty
24968 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24969 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24970
24971 @table @asis
24972 @item Synopsis:
24973 @smallexample
24974 int isatty(int fd);
24975 @end smallexample
24976
24977 @item Request:
24978 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24979
24980 @item Return value:
24981 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24982
24983 @item Errors:
24984
24985 @table @code
24986 @item EINTR
24987 The call was interrupted by the user.
24988 @end table
24989
24990 @end table
24991
24992 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
24993 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
24994 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
24995 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
24996 needed.
24997
24998
24999 @node system
25000 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25001 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25002
25003 @table @asis
25004 @item Synopsis:
25005 @smallexample
25006 int system(const char *command);
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 @item Request:
25010 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25011
25012 @item Return value:
25013 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25014 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25015 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25016 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25017 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25018 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25019 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25020
25021 @item Errors:
25022
25023 @table @code
25024 @item EINTR
25025 The call was interrupted by the user.
25026 @end table
25027
25028 @end table
25029
25030 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25031 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25032 the host is simplified before it's returned
25033 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25034 is discarded, and the return value consists
25035 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25036
25037 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25038 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25039 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25040
25041 @table @code
25042 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25043 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25044 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25045 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25046
25047 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25048 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25049 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25050 protocol.
25051 @end table
25052
25053 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25054 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25055 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25056
25057 @menu
25058 * Integral datatypes::
25059 * Pointer values::
25060 * Memory transfer::
25061 * struct stat::
25062 * struct timeval::
25063 @end menu
25064
25065 @node Integral datatypes
25066 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25067 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25068
25069 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25070 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25071 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25072
25073 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25074 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25075
25076 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25077
25078 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25079 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25080
25081 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25082
25083 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25084 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25085 byte order.
25086
25087 @node Pointer values
25088 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25089 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25090
25091 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25092 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25093 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25094 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25095
25096 @smallexample
25097 @code{1aaf/12}
25098 @end smallexample
25099
25100 @noindent
25101 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25102 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25103 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25104 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25105
25106 @smallexample
25107 @code{123456/d}
25108 @end smallexample
25109
25110 @node Memory transfer
25111 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25112 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25113
25114 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25115 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25116 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25117 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25118 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25119 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25120 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25121
25122
25123 @node struct stat
25124 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25125 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25126
25127 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25128 is defined as follows:
25129
25130 @smallexample
25131 struct stat @{
25132 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25133 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25134 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25135 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25136 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25137 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25138 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25139 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25140 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25141 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25142 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25143 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25144 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25145 @};
25146 @end smallexample
25147
25148 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25149 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25150 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25151
25152 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25153 range of values.
25154
25155 @table @code
25156
25157 @item st_dev
25158 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25159
25160 @item st_ino
25161 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25162
25163 @item st_mode
25164 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25165 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25166
25167 @item st_uid
25168 @itemx st_gid
25169 @itemx st_rdev
25170 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25171
25172 @item st_atime
25173 @itemx st_mtime
25174 @itemx st_ctime
25175 These values have a host and file system dependent
25176 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25177 support exact timing values.
25178 @end table
25179
25180 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25181 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25182 continuing.
25183
25184 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25185 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25186 get truncated on the target.
25187
25188 @node struct timeval
25189 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25190 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25191
25192 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25193 is defined as follows:
25194
25195 @smallexample
25196 struct timeval @{
25197 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25198 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25199 @};
25200 @end smallexample
25201
25202 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25203 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25204 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25205
25206 @node Constants
25207 @subsection Constants
25208 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25209
25210 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25211 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25212 values before and after the call as needed.
25213
25214 @menu
25215 * Open flags::
25216 * mode_t values::
25217 * Errno values::
25218 * Lseek flags::
25219 * Limits::
25220 @end menu
25221
25222 @node Open flags
25223 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25224 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25225
25226 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25227
25228 @smallexample
25229 O_RDONLY 0x0
25230 O_WRONLY 0x1
25231 O_RDWR 0x2
25232 O_APPEND 0x8
25233 O_CREAT 0x200
25234 O_TRUNC 0x400
25235 O_EXCL 0x800
25236 @end smallexample
25237
25238 @node mode_t values
25239 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25240 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25241
25242 All values are given in octal representation.
25243
25244 @smallexample
25245 S_IFREG 0100000
25246 S_IFDIR 040000
25247 S_IRUSR 0400
25248 S_IWUSR 0200
25249 S_IXUSR 0100
25250 S_IRGRP 040
25251 S_IWGRP 020
25252 S_IXGRP 010
25253 S_IROTH 04
25254 S_IWOTH 02
25255 S_IXOTH 01
25256 @end smallexample
25257
25258 @node Errno values
25259 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25260 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25261
25262 All values are given in decimal representation.
25263
25264 @smallexample
25265 EPERM 1
25266 ENOENT 2
25267 EINTR 4
25268 EBADF 9
25269 EACCES 13
25270 EFAULT 14
25271 EBUSY 16
25272 EEXIST 17
25273 ENODEV 19
25274 ENOTDIR 20
25275 EISDIR 21
25276 EINVAL 22
25277 ENFILE 23
25278 EMFILE 24
25279 EFBIG 27
25280 ENOSPC 28
25281 ESPIPE 29
25282 EROFS 30
25283 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25284 EUNKNOWN 9999
25285 @end smallexample
25286
25287 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25288 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25289
25290 @node Lseek flags
25291 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25292 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25293
25294 @smallexample
25295 SEEK_SET 0
25296 SEEK_CUR 1
25297 SEEK_END 2
25298 @end smallexample
25299
25300 @node Limits
25301 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25302 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25303
25304 All values are given in decimal representation.
25305
25306 @smallexample
25307 INT_MIN -2147483648
25308 INT_MAX 2147483647
25309 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25310 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25311 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25312 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25313 @end smallexample
25314
25315 @node File-I/O Examples
25316 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25317 @cindex file-i/o examples
25318
25319 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25320 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25321
25322 @smallexample
25323 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25324 @emph{request memory read from target}
25325 -> @code{m1234,6}
25326 <- XXXXXX
25327 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25328 -> @code{F6}
25329 @end smallexample
25330
25331 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25332 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25333
25334 @smallexample
25335 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25336 @emph{request memory write to target}
25337 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25338 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25339 -> @code{F6}
25340 @end smallexample
25341
25342 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25343 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25344
25345 @smallexample
25346 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25347 -> @code{F-1,9}
25348 @end smallexample
25349
25350 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
25351 host is called:
25352
25353 @smallexample
25354 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25355 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25356 <- @code{T02}
25357 @end smallexample
25358
25359 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
25360 host is called:
25361
25362 @smallexample
25363 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25364 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25365 <- @code{T02}
25366 @end smallexample
25367
25368 @node Memory map format
25369 @section Memory map format
25370 @cindex memory map format
25371
25372 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25373 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25374 memory map.
25375
25376 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25377 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25378 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25379
25380 @smallexample
25381 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25382 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25383 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25384 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25385 <memory-map>
25386 region...
25387 </memory-map>
25388 @end smallexample
25389
25390 Each region can be either:
25391
25392 @itemize
25393
25394 @item
25395 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25396 bytes from there:
25397
25398 @smallexample
25399 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25400 @end smallexample
25401
25402
25403 @item
25404 A region of read-only memory:
25405
25406 @smallexample
25407 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25408 @end smallexample
25409
25410
25411 @item
25412 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25413 bytes in length:
25414
25415 @smallexample
25416 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25417 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25418 </memory>
25419 @end smallexample
25420
25421 @end itemize
25422
25423 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25424 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25425 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25426
25427 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25428
25429 @smallexample
25430 <!-- ................................................... -->
25431 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25432 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25433 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25434 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25435 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25436 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25437 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25438 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25439 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25440 and its type, or device. -->
25441 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25442 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25443 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25444 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25445 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25446 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25447 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25448 @end smallexample
25449
25450 @include agentexpr.texi
25451
25452 @include gpl.texi
25453
25454 @raisesections
25455 @include fdl.texi
25456 @lowersections
25457
25458 @node Index
25459 @unnumbered Index
25460
25461 @printindex cp
25462
25463 @tex
25464 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25465 % meantime:
25466 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25467 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25468 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25469 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25470 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25471 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25472 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25473 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25474 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25475 \page\colophon
25476 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25477 @end tex
25478
25479 @bye
This page took 0.615433 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.